blob: 378584825b9389da1947617da684cce6eb7eb2e9 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "Sema.h"
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +000015#include "SemaInit.h"
John McCall5cebab12009-11-18 07:57:50 +000016#include "Lookup.h"
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +000017#include "AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Chris Lattnercb6a3822006-11-10 06:20:45 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Daniel Dunbar6e8aa532008-08-11 05:35:13 +000019#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000021#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +000022#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Naroff021ca182008-05-29 21:12:08 +000023#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000024#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000025#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +000026#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000027#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000028#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
29#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +000030#include "clang/Parse/DeclSpec.h"
Chris Lattner07d754a2008-10-26 23:43:26 +000031#include "clang/Parse/Designator.h"
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +000032#include "clang/Parse/Scope.h"
Douglas Gregorb53edfb2009-11-10 19:49:08 +000033#include "clang/Parse/Template.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000034using namespace clang;
35
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +000036
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000037/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
38/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
39///
40/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
41/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
42/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
43/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
44/// function is being used.
45///
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000046/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
47/// decls.
48///
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000049/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
50/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000051///
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000052bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000053 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000054 if (D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000055 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Loc);
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000056 }
57
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000058 // See if the decl is unavailable
59 if (D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
60 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
61 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
62 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +000063
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000064 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000065 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000066 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
67 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
68 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
69 return true;
70 }
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000071 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000072
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000073 return false;
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000074}
75
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000076/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000077/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000078/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
79///
80void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000081 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000082 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000083 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000084 return;
Douglas Gregorc298ffc2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000085
86 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
87 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000088 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
89 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000090
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +000091 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
92 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000093 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +000094 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
95 int isMethod = 0;
96 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
97 // skip over named parameters.
98 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
99 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
100 if (nullPos)
101 --nullPos;
102 else
103 ++i;
104 }
105 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
106 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000107 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000108 // skip over named parameters.
109 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
110 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
111 if (nullPos)
112 --nullPos;
113 else
114 ++i;
115 }
116 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000117 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000118 // block or function pointer call.
119 QualType Ty = V->getType();
120 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000121 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000122 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
123 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000124 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
125 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
126 unsigned k;
127 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
128 if (nullPos)
129 --nullPos;
130 else
131 ++i;
132 }
133 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
134 }
135 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
136 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000137 } else
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000138 return;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000139 } else
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000140 return;
141
142 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000143 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000144 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000145 return;
146 }
147 int sentinel = i;
148 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
149 --sentinelPos;
150 ++i;
151 }
152 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
153 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000154 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000155 return;
156 }
157 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
158 ++i;
159 ++sentinel;
160 }
161 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
Anders Carlsson0b11a3e2009-11-24 17:24:21 +0000162 if (sentinelExpr && (!isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr) &&
Douglas Gregorc298ffc2010-04-22 16:44:27 +0000163 !sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent() &&
164 !sentinelExpr->isValueDependent() &&
Anders Carlsson0b11a3e2009-11-24 17:24:21 +0000165 (!sentinelExpr->getType()->isPointerType() ||
166 !sentinelExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
167 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)))) {
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000168 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000169 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000170 }
171 return;
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000172}
173
Douglas Gregor87f95b02009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000174SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
175 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
176 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
177}
178
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000179//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
180// Standard Promotions and Conversions
181//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
182
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000183/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
184void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
185 QualType Ty = E->getType();
186 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
187
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000188 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000189 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
Anders Carlsson6904f642009-09-01 20:37:18 +0000190 CastExpr::CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000191 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
192 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
193 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
194 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
195 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
196 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
197 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9321c742008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000198 //
199 // C++ 4.2p1:
200 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
201 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
202 //
203 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
204 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson8fc489d2009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000205 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
206 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000207 }
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000208}
209
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000210void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
211 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000212
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000213 QualType Ty = E->getType();
214 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
215 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
216 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
217 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
218 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
219 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
220 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
221 // rvalue is T
222 //
223 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000224 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
225 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000226 // type of the lvalue.
227 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
228 }
229}
230
231
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000232/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000233/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000234/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
235/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
236/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
237Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
238 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
239 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000240
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000241 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
242 //
243 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
244 // unsigned int may be used:
245 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
246 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
247 // and unsigned int.
248 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
249 //
250 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
251 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
252 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
253 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000254 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
255 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000256 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000257 return Expr;
258 }
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000259 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000260 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000261 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000262 return Expr;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000263 }
264
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000265 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000266 return Expr;
267}
268
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000269/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000270/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000271/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
272void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
273 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
274 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000275
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000276 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000277 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>())
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000278 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000279 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
280 CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000281
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000282 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
283}
284
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000285/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
286/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
287/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
288/// completely illegal.
289bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT) {
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000290 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000291
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000292 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCInterfaceType() &&
293 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
294 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
295 << Expr->getType() << CT))
296 return true;
Douglas Gregor7ca84af2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000297
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000298 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000299 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000300 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
301 << Expr->getType() << CT))
302 return true;
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000303
304 return false;
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000305}
306
307
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000308/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
309/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000310/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000311/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
312/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
313/// GCC.
314QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
315 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000316 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000317 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000318
319 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000320
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000321 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000322 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000323 QualType lhs =
324 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000325 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000326 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000327
328 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
329 if (lhs == rhs)
330 return lhs;
331
332 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
333 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
334 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
335 return lhs;
336
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000337 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000338 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000339 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
340 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000341 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000342 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
343 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
344
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000345 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000346 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000347 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
348 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000349 return destType;
350}
351
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000352//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
353// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
354//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
355
356
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000357/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000358/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
359/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
360/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
361/// string.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000362///
363Action::OwningExprResult
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000364Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000365 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
366
Chris Lattner8a24e582009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000367 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Steve Naroff4f88b312007-03-13 22:37:02 +0000368 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000369 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000370
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +0000371 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000372 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
373 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000374
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000375 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscbad7252008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000376 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000377 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000378
379 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
John McCallc33dec32010-03-15 10:54:44 +0000380 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings )
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000381 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000382
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000383 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
384 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
385 // strings.
386 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerd42c29f2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000387 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000388 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000389
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000390 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000391 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
Chris Lattnerf83b5af2009-02-18 06:40:38 +0000392 Literal.GetStringLength(),
393 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
394 &StringTokLocs[0],
395 StringTokLocs.size()));
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000396}
397
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000398/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
399/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
400/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
401/// for values inside the block or for globals).
402///
Douglas Gregor4f13beb2010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000403/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000404/// up-to-date.
405///
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000406static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000407 ValueDecl *VD) {
408 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
409 // we wanted to.
410 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
411 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000412
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000413 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
414 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
415 return false;
416
417 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
418 // snapshot it.
419 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
420 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000421 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
422 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000423
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000424 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
425 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
426
427 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
428 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
429 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
430 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000431 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
432 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000433
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000434 if (!NextBlock)
435 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000436
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000437 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
438 // having a reference outside it.
439 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
440 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000441
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000442 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
443 // a snapshot as well.
444 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
445 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000446
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000447 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000448}
449
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000450
451
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +0000452/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000453Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallce546572009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000454Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000455 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000456 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
457 Diag(Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000458 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000459 << D->getDeclName();
460 return ExprError();
461 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000462
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000463 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000464 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
465 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
466 // visible.
467 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000468 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
469 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000470 Diag(Loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000471 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000472 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000473 << D->getIdentifier();
474 return ExprError();
475 }
476 }
477 }
478 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000479
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000480 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, D);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000481
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000482 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
483 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
484 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Douglas Gregored6c7442009-11-23 11:41:28 +0000485 D, Loc, Ty));
Douglas Gregorc7acfdf2009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000486}
487
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000488/// getObjectForAnonymousRecordDecl - Retrieve the (unnamed) field or
489/// variable corresponding to the anonymous union or struct whose type
490/// is Record.
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +0000491static Decl *getObjectForAnonymousRecordDecl(ASTContext &Context,
492 RecordDecl *Record) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000493 assert(Record->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000494 "Record must be an anonymous struct or union!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000495
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +0000496 // FIXME: Once Decls are directly linked together, this will be an O(1)
497 // operation rather than a slow walk through DeclContext's vector (which
498 // itself will be eliminated). DeclGroups might make this even better.
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000499 DeclContext *Ctx = Record->getDeclContext();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000500 for (DeclContext::decl_iterator D = Ctx->decls_begin(),
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +0000501 DEnd = Ctx->decls_end();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000502 D != DEnd; ++D) {
503 if (*D == Record) {
504 // The object for the anonymous struct/union directly
505 // follows its type in the list of declarations.
506 ++D;
507 assert(D != DEnd && "Missing object for anonymous record");
Douglas Gregor6e6ad602009-01-20 01:17:11 +0000508 assert(!cast<NamedDecl>(*D)->getDeclName() && "Decl should be unnamed");
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000509 return *D;
510 }
511 }
512
513 assert(false && "Missing object for anonymous record");
514 return 0;
515}
516
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000517/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
518/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
519/// actual member.
520///
521/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
522/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
523/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
524/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
525/// we found.
526///
527/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
528/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
529/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
530VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
531 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000532 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
533 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
534 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
535
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000536 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000537 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
538 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
539 do {
540 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +0000541 Decl *AnonObject = getObjectForAnonymousRecordDecl(Context, Record);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000542 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000543 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000544 else {
545 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
546 break;
547 }
548 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000549 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000550 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000551
552 return BaseObject;
553}
554
555Sema::OwningExprResult
556Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
557 FieldDecl *Field,
558 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
559 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
560 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000561 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000562 AnonFields);
563
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000564 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
565 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
566 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
567 // found via name lookup.
568 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000569 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000570 if (BaseObject) {
571 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
572 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +0000573 if (BaseObjectExpr) BaseObjectExpr->Destroy(Context);
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000574 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000575 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000576 SourceLocation());
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000577 BaseQuals
578 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000579 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
580 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
581 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
582 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
583 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000584 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000585 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
586 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
587 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000588 BaseQuals
589 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000590 } else {
591 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
592 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
593 // program our base object expression is "this".
594 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
595 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000596 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000597 = Context.getTagDeclType(
598 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
599 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000600 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000601 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
602 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
603 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor4b654412009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000604 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000605 MD->getThisType(Context),
606 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000607 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
608 }
609 } else {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000610 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
611 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000612 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000613 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000614 }
615
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000616 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000617 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
618 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000619 }
620
621 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
622 // anonymous struct/union.
623 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000624 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000625 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
626 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
627 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
628 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000629 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
630 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
631
632 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
633 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
634 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
635 ResultQuals.removeConst();
636
637 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
638 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
639
640 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
641 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
642
643 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
644 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
645 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
646
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000647 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000648 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000649 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000650 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
651 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000652 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000653 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000654 }
655
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000656 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000657}
658
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000659/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationName, its location, and
660/// possibly a list of template arguments.
661///
662/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
663/// DecomposeTemplateName.
664///
665/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
666/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
667/// some way.
668static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
669 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
670 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
671 DeclarationName &Name,
672 SourceLocation &NameLoc,
673 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
674 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
675 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
676 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
677
678 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
679 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
680 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
681 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
682 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
683
684 TemplateName TName =
685 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
686
687 Name = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName);
688 NameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
689 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
690 } else {
691 Name = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
692 NameLoc = Id.StartLocation;
693 TemplateArgs = 0;
694 }
695}
696
697/// Decompose the given template name into a list of lookup results.
698///
699/// The unqualified ID must name a non-dependent template, which can
700/// be more easily tested by checking whether DecomposeUnqualifiedId
701/// found template arguments.
702static void DecomposeTemplateName(LookupResult &R, const UnqualifiedId &Id) {
703 assert(Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId);
704 TemplateName TName =
705 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
706
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000707 if (TemplateDecl *TD = TName.getAsTemplateDecl())
708 R.addDecl(TD);
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +0000709 else if (OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = TName.getAsOverloadedTemplate())
710 for (OverloadedTemplateStorage::iterator I = OT->begin(), E = OT->end();
711 I != E; ++I)
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000712 R.addDecl(*I);
John McCalla9ee3252009-11-22 02:49:43 +0000713
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000714 R.resolveKind();
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +0000715}
716
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000717/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
718/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
719/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000720static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000721 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
722 return false;
723
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000724 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
725 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
726 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
727 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
728 if (!BaseRT) return false;
729
730 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000731 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000732 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
733 return false;
734 }
735
736 return true;
737}
738
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000739/// Determines whether we can lookup this id-expression now or whether
740/// we have to wait until template instantiation is complete.
741static bool IsDependentIdExpression(Sema &SemaRef, const CXXScopeSpec &SS) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000742 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000743
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000744 // If the qualifier scope isn't computable, it's definitely dependent.
745 if (!DC) return true;
746
747 // If the qualifier scope doesn't name a record, we can always look into it.
748 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) return false;
749
750 // We can't look into record types unless they're fully-formed.
751 if (!IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))) return true;
752
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000753 return false;
754}
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000755
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000756/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
757/// the prospective base classes.
758static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
759 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
760 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000761 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000762 return false;
763
Douglas Gregor0a5a2212010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000764 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000765 if (!RD) return false;
766 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
767
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000768 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
769 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
770 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
771 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
772 if (!BaseRT) return false;
773
774 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000775 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
776 return false;
777 }
778
779 return true;
780}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000781
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000782enum IMAKind {
783 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
784 IMA_Static,
785
786 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
787 IMA_Mixed,
788
789 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
790 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
791 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
792
793 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
794 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
795 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
796
797 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
798 IMA_Instance,
799
800 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
801 IMA_Unresolved,
802
803 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
804 /// context is not an instance method.
805 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
806
807 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
808 /// non-class context.
809 IMA_AnonymousMember,
810
811 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
812 /// context is not an instance method.
813 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
814
815 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
816 /// class.
817 IMA_Error_Unrelated
818};
819
820/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
821/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
822/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
823/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
824/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
825/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
826static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
827 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000828 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000829
830 bool isStaticContext =
831 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext) ||
832 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)->isStatic());
833
834 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
835 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
836
837 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
838 bool hasNonInstance = false;
839 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
840 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000841 NamedDecl *D = *I;
842 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000843 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
844
845 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
846 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
847 // that's a special case.
848 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
849 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
850 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
851 }
852 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
853 }
854 else
855 hasNonInstance = true;
856 }
857
858 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
859 // member reference.
860 if (Classes.empty())
861 return IMA_Static;
862
863 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
864 // an implicit member reference.
865 if (isStaticContext)
866 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
867
868 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
869 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
870 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
871 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
872 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)->getParent(),
873 Classes))
874 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
875
876 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
877}
878
879/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
880static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
881 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
882 const LookupResult &R) {
883 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
884 SourceRange Range(Loc);
885 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
886
887 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
888 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
889 if (MD->isStatic()) {
890 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
891 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
892 << Range << R.getLookupName();
893 return;
894 }
895 }
896
897 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
898 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
899 return;
900 }
901
902 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000903}
904
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000905/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
906///
907/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +0000908bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000909 LookupResult &R) {
910 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
911
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000912 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000913 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000914 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
915 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000916 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000917 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000918 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
919 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000920
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000921 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
922 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
923 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
924 // dependent name.
925 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty()? CurContext : 0;
926 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000927 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
928 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
929
930 if (!R.empty()) {
931 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
932 R.suppressDiagnostics();
933
934 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
935 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
936 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
937 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
938
939 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
940 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
941 // Actually quite difficult!
942 if (isInstance)
943 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +0000944 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000945 else
946 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
947
948 // Do we really want to note all of these?
949 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
950 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
951
952 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
953 return false;
954 }
955 }
956 }
957
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000958 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000959 DeclarationName Corrected;
960 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS))) {
961 if (!R.empty()) {
962 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
963 if (SS.isEmpty())
964 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
965 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
966 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
967 else
968 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
969 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
970 << SS.getRange()
971 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
972 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
973 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
974 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
975 << ND->getDeclName();
976
977 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
978 return false;
979 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000980
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000981 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
982 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
983 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
984 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
985 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
986 // to recover well anyway.
987 if (SS.isEmpty())
988 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
989 else
990 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
991 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
992 << SS.getRange();
993
994 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
995 return true;
996 }
997 } else {
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000998 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000999 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001000 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001001 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001002 else
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001003 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001004 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
1005 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001006 return true;
1007 }
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001008 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001009 }
1010
1011 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
1012 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
1013 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
1014 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1015 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1016 << SS.getRange();
1017 return true;
1018 }
1019
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001020 // Give up, we can't recover.
1021 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1022 return true;
1023}
1024
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001025Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001026 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001027 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1028 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1029 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
1030 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1031 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1032
1033 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregored8f2882009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001034 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001035
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001036 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001037
1038 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
1039 DeclarationName Name;
1040 SourceLocation NameLoc;
1041 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001042 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
1043 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001044
Douglas Gregor4ea80432008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001045 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001046
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001047 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1048 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001049 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1050 // (note: handled after lookup)
1051 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1052 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1053 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001054 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1055 // names a dependent type.
1056 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1057 // we need to handle these differently.
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001058 if ((Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1059 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) ||
1060 (SS.isSet() && IsDependentIdExpression(*this, SS))) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001061 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, Name, NameLoc,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00001062 isAddressOfOperand,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001063 TemplateArgs);
1064 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001065
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001066 // Perform the required lookup.
1067 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1068 if (TemplateArgs) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001069 // Just re-use the lookup done by isTemplateName.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001070 DecomposeTemplateName(R, Id);
Douglas Gregor9262f472010-04-27 18:19:34 +00001071
1072 // Re-derive the naming class.
1073 if (SS.isSet()) {
1074 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier
1075 = static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier *>(SS.getScopeRep());
1076 if (const Type *Ty = Qualifier->getAsType())
1077 if (CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
1078 R.setNamingClass(NamingClass);
1079 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001080 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001081 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
1082 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001083
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001084 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1085 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001086 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
1087 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001088 if (E.isInvalid())
1089 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001090
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001091 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1092 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Steve Naroffebf4cb42008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001093 }
Chris Lattner59a25942008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001094 }
Douglas Gregorf15f5d32009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001095
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001096 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1097 return ExprError();
1098
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001099 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1100 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001101 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001102
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001103 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Bill Wendling4073ed52007-02-13 01:51:42 +00001104 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001105 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1106 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1107 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1108 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1109 }
1110
1111 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1112 // call, diagnose the problem.
1113 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001114 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R))
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001115 return ExprError();
1116
1117 assert(!R.empty() &&
1118 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001119
1120 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1121 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001122 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001123 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1124 R.clear();
1125 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
1126 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1127 return move(E);
1128 }
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00001129 }
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001130 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001131
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001132 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1133 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1134
1135 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001136 // Warn about constructs like:
1137 // if (void *X = foo()) { ... } else { X }.
1138 // In the else block, the pointer is always false.
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001139 if (Var->isDeclaredInCondition() && Var->getType()->isScalarType()) {
1140 Scope *CheckS = S;
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001141 while (CheckS && CheckS->getControlParent()) {
Chris Lattnerdf742642010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001142 if ((CheckS->getFlags() & Scope::ElseScope) &&
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001143 CheckS->getControlParent()->isDeclScope(DeclPtrTy::make(Var))) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001144 ExprError(Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_value_always_zero)
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001145 << Var->getDeclName()
Chris Lattnerdf742642010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001146 << (Var->getType()->isPointerType() ? 2 :
1147 Var->getType()->isBooleanType() ? 1 : 0));
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001148 break;
1149 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001150
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001151 // Move to the parent of this scope.
1152 CheckS = CheckS->getParent();
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001153 }
1154 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001155 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001156 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1157 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1158 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1159 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1160 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1161 // type.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001162 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001163 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001164
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001165 QualType T = Func->getType();
1166 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001167 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001168 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001169 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001170 }
1171 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001172
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001173 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
1174 // C++ [expr.prim.general]p6:
1175 // Within the definition of a non-static member function, an
1176 // identifier that names a non-static member is transformed to a
1177 // class member access expression.
1178 // But note that &SomeClass::foo is grammatically distinct, even
1179 // though we don't parse it that way.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001180 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001181 bool isAbstractMemberPointer = (isAddressOfOperand && !SS.isEmpty());
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001182 if (!isAbstractMemberPointer)
1183 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001184 }
1185
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001186 if (TemplateArgs)
1187 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001188
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001189 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1190}
1191
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001192/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
1193Sema::OwningExprResult
1194Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1195 LookupResult &R,
1196 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1197 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1198 case IMA_Instance:
1199 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1200
1201 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1202 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1203 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1204 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1205
1206 case IMA_Mixed:
1207 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1208 case IMA_Unresolved:
1209 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1210
1211 case IMA_Static:
1212 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1213 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1214 if (TemplateArgs)
1215 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1216 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1217
1218 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1219 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1220 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1221 return ExprError();
1222 }
1223
1224 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1225 return ExprError();
1226}
1227
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001228/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1229/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1230/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1231/// this path.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001232Sema::OwningExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001233Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001234 DeclarationName Name,
1235 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1236 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001237 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001238 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, Name, NameLoc, 0);
1239
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001240 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS))
1241 return ExprError();
1242
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001243 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1244 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1245
1246 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1247 return ExprError();
1248
1249 if (R.empty()) {
1250 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_no_member) << Name << DC << SS.getRange();
1251 return ExprError();
1252 }
1253
1254 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1255}
1256
1257/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1258/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1259/// additional lookup.
1260///
1261/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1262/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1263///
1264/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
1265Sema::OwningExprResult
1266Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnera36ec422010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001267 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001268 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001269 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001270
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001271 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1272 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1273 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1274 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1275 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1276
1277 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1278 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1279 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001280 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001281
1282 bool LookForIvars;
1283 if (Lookup.empty())
1284 LookForIvars = true;
1285 else if (IsClassMethod)
1286 LookForIvars = false;
1287 else
1288 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1289 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian45878032010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001290 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001291 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001292 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001293 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1294 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1295 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1296 if (IsClassMethod)
1297 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1298 << IV->getDeclName());
1299
1300 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1301 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1302 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1303 return ExprError();
1304
1305 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1306 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1307 return ExprError();
1308
1309 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1310 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1311 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1312 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1313
1314 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1315 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1316 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1317 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001318 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001319 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
1320 OwningExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
1321 SelfName, false, false);
1322 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1323 return Owned(new (Context)
1324 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1325 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1326 }
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001327 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001328 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001329 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001330 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1331 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1332 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1333 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1334 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1335 }
1336 }
1337
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001338 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1339 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1340 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1341 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1342 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1343 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1344 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1345 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1346 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1347 }
1348 }
1349 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001350 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1351 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001352}
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001353
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001354/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1355///
1356/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1357///
1358/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1359/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1360/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1361/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1362///
1363/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1364/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1365/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1366/// the class declaring the member.
1367///
1368/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1369/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1370/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001371bool
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001372Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1373 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001374 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001375 NamedDecl *Member) {
1376 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1377 if (!RD)
1378 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001379
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001380 QualType DestRecordType;
1381 QualType DestType;
1382 QualType FromRecordType;
1383 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1384 bool PointerConversions = false;
1385 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1386 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001387
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001388 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1389 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1390 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1391 PointerConversions = true;
1392 } else {
1393 DestType = DestRecordType;
1394 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001395 }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001396 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1397 if (Method->isStatic())
1398 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001399
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001400 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1401 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001402
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001403 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1404 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1405 PointerConversions = true;
1406 } else {
1407 FromRecordType = FromType;
1408 DestType = DestRecordType;
1409 }
1410 } else {
1411 // No conversion necessary.
1412 return false;
1413 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001414
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001415 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1416 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001417
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001418 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1419 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1420 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001421
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001422 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1423 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1424
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001425 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001426 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001427 // class name.
1428 //
1429 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1430 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1431 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1432 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1433 //
1434 // class Base { public: int x; };
1435 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1436 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1437 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1438 //
1439 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1440 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1441 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1442 // }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001443 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001444 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1445 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1446 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1447
1448 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1449
1450 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1451 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1452 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1453 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001454 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001455 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001456 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001457 return true;
1458
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001459 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001460 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001461 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001462 /*isLvalue=*/!PointerConversions, BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001463
1464 FromType = QType;
1465 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1466
1467 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1468 // we're done.
1469 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1470 return false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001471 }
1472 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001473
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001474 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001475
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001476 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1477 // down to the using declaration's type.
1478 //
1479 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1480 // class ever has member declarations.
1481 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1482 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1483 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1484 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1485
1486 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1487 // conversion is non-trivial.
1488 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1489 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001490 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001491 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001492 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001493 return true;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001494
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001495 QualType UType = URecordType;
1496 if (PointerConversions)
1497 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001498 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001499 /*isLvalue=*/!PointerConversions, BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001500 FromType = UType;
1501 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1502 }
1503
1504 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1505 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1506 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001507 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001508
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001509 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
1510 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1511 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001512 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001513 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001514
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001515 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001516 /*isLvalue=*/!PointerConversions, BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001517 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001518}
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001519
Douglas Gregorf405d7e2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001520/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001521static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedman2cfcef62009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001522 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001523 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
1524 SourceLocation Loc, QualType Ty,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001525 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1526 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1527 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001528 if (SS.isSet()) {
1529 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1530 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001531 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001532
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001533 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001534 Member, FoundDecl, Loc, TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001535}
1536
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001537/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1538/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1539/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1540/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001541Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001542Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1543 LookupResult &R,
1544 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1545 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001546 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1547
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001548 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001549
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001550 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1551 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregor6493d9c2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001552 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001553 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001554 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001555 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001556 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001557
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001558 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1559 // 'this' expression now.
1560 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)->getThisType(Context);
1561 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1562 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001563 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1564 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1565 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1566 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001567 }
1568
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001569 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, This), ThisType,
1570 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1571 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001572 SS,
1573 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1574 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001575}
1576
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001577bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001578 const LookupResult &R,
1579 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001580 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1581 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1582 return false;
1583
1584 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001585 if (SS.isSet())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001586 return false;
1587
1588 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001589 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001590 return false;
1591
1592 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1593 // normal lookup:
1594 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1595 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1596
1597 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1598 // -- a declaration of a class member
1599 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1600 // original decl.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001601 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001602 return false;
1603
1604 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1605 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1606 // using-declaration
1607 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1608 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1609 // turn off ADL anyway).
1610 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1611 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1612 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1613 return false;
1614
1615 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1616 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1617 // template
1618 // And also for builtin functions.
1619 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1620 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1621
1622 // But also builtin functions.
1623 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1624 return false;
1625 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1626 return false;
1627 }
1628
1629 return true;
1630}
1631
1632
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001633/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1634/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1635/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1636/// will in fact be used.
1637static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1638 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1639 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1640 return true;
1641 }
1642
1643 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1644 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1645 return true;
1646 }
1647
1648 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1649 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1650 return true;
1651 }
1652
1653 return false;
1654}
1655
1656Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001657Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001658 LookupResult &R,
1659 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCall3a60c872009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001660 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1661 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor4b4844f2010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001662 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001663 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001664
1665 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1666 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1667 // functions and function templates.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001668 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1669 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001670 return ExprError();
1671
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001672 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1673 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1674 // we've picked a target.
1675 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1676
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001677 bool Dependent
1678 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001679 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001680 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001681 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
1682 SS.getRange(),
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001683 R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
1684 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult());
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001685 ULE->addDecls(R.begin(), R.end());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001686
1687 return Owned(ULE);
1688}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001689
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001690
1691/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
1692Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001693Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001694 SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1695 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001696 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1697 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001698
1699 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1700 return ExprError();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00001701
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001702 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1703 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1704 // a template argument list.
1705 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1706 << Template << SS.getRange();
1707 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1708 return ExprError();
1709 }
1710
1711 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1712 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1713 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001714 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001715 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCallb48971d2009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001716 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001717 return ExprError();
1718 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001719
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001720 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1721 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1722 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1723 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001724 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001725 return ExprError();
1726
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001727 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1728 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001729 return ExprError();
1730
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001731 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1732 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1733 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1734 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001735 //
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001736 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1737 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1738 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001739 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001740 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump7dafa0d2010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001741 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1742 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1743 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1744 return ExprError();
1745 }
1746
Fariborz Jahanianfa24e102010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001747 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump8971a862010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001748 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1749 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1750 return ExprError();
1751 }
1752
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001753 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001754 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001755 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001756 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001757 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001758 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1759 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001760 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001761
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001762 ExprTy.addConst();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001763 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001764 constAdded));
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001765 }
1766 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1767 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001768
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001769 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(), Loc, &SS);
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001770}
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001771
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001772Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
1773 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001774 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001775
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001776 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001777 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001778 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1779 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1780 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001781 }
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001782
Chris Lattnera81a0272008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001783 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1784 // string.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001785
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001786 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
1787 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001788 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001789 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001790 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001791
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001792 QualType ResTy;
1793 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1794 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1795 } else {
Anders Carlsson5bd8d192010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001796 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001797
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001798 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001799 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001800 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1801 }
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001802 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001803}
1804
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001805Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001806 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001807 bool Invalid = false;
1808 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1809 if (Invalid)
1810 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001811
Benjamin Kramer0a1abd42010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001812 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1813 PP);
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001814 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001815 return ExprError();
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001816
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001817 QualType Ty;
1818 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1819 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1820 else if (Literal.isWide())
1821 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedmaneb1df702010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001822 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1823 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001824 else
1825 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001826
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001827 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1828 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001829 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001830}
1831
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001832Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
1833 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001834 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1835 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner9240b3e2009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001836 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattnerc4c18192009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001837 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001838 return Owned(new (Context) IntegerLiteral(llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff5faaef72009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001839 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001840 }
Ted Kremeneke9814182009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001841
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001842 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattnera1cf5f92008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001843 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1844 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Steve Naroff8160ea22007-03-06 01:09:46 +00001845 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001846
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001847 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001848 bool Invalid = false;
1849 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1850 if (Invalid)
1851 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001852
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001853 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Steve Naroff451d8f162007-03-12 23:22:38 +00001854 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001855 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001856 return ExprError();
1857
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001858 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001859
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001860 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001861 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001862 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001863 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001864 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001865 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001866 else
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001867 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001868
1869 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1870
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001871 using llvm::APFloat;
1872 APFloat Val(Format);
1873
1874 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall122c8312009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001875
1876 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1877 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1878 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1879 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001880 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001881 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001882 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001883 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001884 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
1885 } else {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001886 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001887 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
1888 }
1889
1890 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
1891 << Ty
1892 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
1893 }
1894
1895 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Chris Lattnere4edb8e2009-06-29 17:34:55 +00001896 Res = new (Context) FloatingLiteral(Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001897
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001898 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001899 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001900 } else {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001901 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001902
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001903 // long long is a C99 feature.
1904 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth4a1ee052007-08-29 22:13:52 +00001905 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001906 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
1907
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001908 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001909 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001910
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001911 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
1912 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
1913 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001914 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
1915 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001916 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001917 } else {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001918 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
1919 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001920
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001921 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
1922 // be an unsigned int.
1923 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
1924
1925 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001926 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner7b939cf2007-08-23 21:58:08 +00001927 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
1928 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001929 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001930
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001931 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
1932 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
1933 // Does it fit in a signed int?
1934 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001935 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001936 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001937 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001938 Width = IntSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001939 }
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001940 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001941
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001942 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001943 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001944 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001945
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001946 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
1947 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
1948 // Does it fit in a signed long?
1949 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001950 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001951 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001952 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001953 Width = LongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001954 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001955 }
1956
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001957 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001958 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001959 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001960
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001961 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
1962 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
1963 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
1964 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001965 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001966 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001967 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001968 Width = LongLongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001969 }
1970 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001971
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001972 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
1973 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001974 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001975 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001976 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001977 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001978 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001979
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001980 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
1981 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001982 }
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001983 Res = new (Context) IntegerLiteral(ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001984 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001985
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001986 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
1987 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001988 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001989 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001990
1991 return Owned(Res);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001992}
1993
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001994Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
1995 SourceLocation R, ExprArg Val) {
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00001996 Expr *E = Val.takeAs<Expr>();
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001997 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001998 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001999}
2000
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00002001/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00002002/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002003bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002004 SourceLocation OpLoc,
2005 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
2006 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002007 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2008 return false;
2009
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002010 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2011 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2012 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2013 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2014 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2015 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2016
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002017 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002018 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002019 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002020 if (isSizeof)
2021 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2022 return false;
2023 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002024
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002025 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002026 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002027 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2028 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002029 return false;
2030 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002031
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002032 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002033 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2034 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002035 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002036
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002037 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
Fariborz Jahanian1dcb3222009-04-24 17:34:33 +00002038 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCInterfaceType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002039 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattnercd2a8c52009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002040 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2041 return true;
Chris Lattner37920f52009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002042 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002043
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002044 return false;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002045}
2046
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002047bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2048 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2049 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002050
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002051 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002052 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2053 return false;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002054
2055 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2056 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2057 return false;
2058
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002059 if (E->getBitField()) {
2060 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2061 return true;
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002062 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002063
2064 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2065 // bit-field.
2066 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002067 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002068 return false;
2069
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002070 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2071}
2072
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002073/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002074Action::OwningExprResult
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002075Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002076 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002077 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002078 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002079 return ExprError();
2080
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002081 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002082
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002083 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2084 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2085 return ExprError();
2086
2087 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002088 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002089 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2090 R.getEnd()));
2091}
2092
2093/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2094/// operand.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002095Action::OwningExprResult
2096Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002097 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2098 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2099 bool isInvalid = false;
2100 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2101 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2102 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2103 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002104 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002105 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2106 isInvalid = true;
2107 } else {
2108 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2109 }
2110
2111 if (isInvalid)
2112 return ExprError();
2113
2114 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2115 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2116 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2117 R.getEnd()));
2118}
2119
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002120/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2121/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2122/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002123Action::OwningExprResult
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002124Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2125 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Chris Lattner0d8b1a12006-11-20 04:34:45 +00002126 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002127 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002128
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002129 if (isType) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002130 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
2131 (void) GetTypeFromParser(TyOrEx, &TInfo);
2132 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002133 }
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002134
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002135 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
2136 Action::OwningExprResult Result
2137 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2138
2139 if (Result.isInvalid())
2140 DeleteExpr(ArgEx);
2141
2142 return move(Result);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002143}
2144
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002145QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002146 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2147 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002148
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002149 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002150 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002151 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002152
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002153 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2154 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2155 return V->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002156
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002157 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002158 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2159 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002160 return QualType();
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002161}
2162
2163
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002164
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002165Action::OwningExprResult
2166Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2167 tok::TokenKind Kind, ExprArg Input) {
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002168 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
2169 switch (Kind) {
2170 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
2171 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostInc; break;
2172 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostDec; break;
2173 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002174
Eli Friedmancfdd40c2009-11-18 03:38:04 +00002175 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, move(Input));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002176}
2177
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002178Action::OwningExprResult
2179Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2180 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002181 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
2182 Base = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Base));
2183
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002184 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get()),
2185 *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002186
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002187 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002188 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
2189 Base.release();
2190 Idx.release();
2191 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2192 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2193 }
2194
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002195 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002196 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman254a1a22008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002197 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2198 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2199 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002200 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, move(Base),move(Idx));
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002201 }
2202
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002203 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(move(Base), LLoc, move(Idx), RLoc);
2204}
2205
2206
2207Action::OwningExprResult
2208Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2209 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2210 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get());
2211 Expr *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
2212
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002213 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002214 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2215 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2216 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002217
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002218 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002219
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002220 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002221 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002222 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002223 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002224 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2225 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002226 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2227 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2228 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2229 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002230 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002231 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2232 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002233 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002234 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattneraee0cfd2007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002235 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002236 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2237 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002238 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002239 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002240 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002241 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2242 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2243 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002244 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002245 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002246 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2247 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2248 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2249 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002250 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattner41977962007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002251 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002252 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begemanc1bf0612009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002253
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002254 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2255 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002256 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2257 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002258 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002259 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2260 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2261 // force the promotion here.
2262 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2263 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002264 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
2265 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002266 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2267
2268 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2269 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002270 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002271 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2272 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2273 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2274 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002275 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
2276 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002277 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2278
2279 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2280 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002281 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroffb3096442007-06-09 03:47:53 +00002282 } else {
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002283 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2284 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002285 }
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002286 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002287 if (!(IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() &&
2288 IndexExpr->getType()->isScalarType()) && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002289 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2290 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffb29cdd52007-07-10 18:23:31 +00002291
Daniel Dunbar4782a6e2009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002292 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinigb7608d72009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002293 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2294 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig914244e2009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002295 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2296
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002297 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002298 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2299 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002300 // incomplete types are not object types.
2301 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2302 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2303 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2304 return ExprError();
2305 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002306
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002307 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002308 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002309 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2310 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002311 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002312
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002313 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
2314 if (ResultType->isObjCInterfaceType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
2315 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2316 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2317 return ExprError();
2318 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002319
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002320 Base.release();
2321 Idx.release();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002322 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002323 ResultType, RLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002324}
2325
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002326QualType Sema::
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002327CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002328 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002329 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbarc0429402009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002330 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2331 // see FIXME there.
2332 //
2333 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2334 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002335 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002336
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002337 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002338 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002339
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002340 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002341 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2342 // to be selected.
2343 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002344
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002345 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2346 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman0359e122009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002347 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002348
2349 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2350 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002351 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002352 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2353 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002354 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002355 do
2356 compStr++;
2357 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002358 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002359 do
2360 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002361 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002362 }
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002363
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002364 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002365 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2366 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002367 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
2368 << std::string(compStr,compStr+1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002369 return QualType();
2370 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002371
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002372 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2373 // operates on.
2374 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002375 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002376
2377 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002378 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002379
2380 while (*compStr) {
2381 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2382 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2383 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2384 return QualType();
2385 }
2386 }
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002387 }
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002388
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002389 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002390 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002391 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002392 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002393 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begemanac8183a2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002394 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002395 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002396 if (HexSwizzle)
2397 CompSize--;
2398
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002399 if (CompSize == 1)
2400 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002401
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002402 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002403 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002404 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2405 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2406 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2407 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffddf5a1d2007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002408 }
2409 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002410}
2411
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002412static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002413 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002414 const Selector &Sel,
2415 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002416
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002417 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002418 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002419 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002420 return OMD;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002421
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002422 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2423 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002424 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002425 Context))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002426 return D;
2427 }
2428 return 0;
2429}
2430
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002431static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002432 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002433 const Selector &Sel,
2434 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002435 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2436 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002437 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002438 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002439 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002440 GDecl = PD;
2441 break;
2442 }
2443 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002444 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002445 GDecl = OMD;
2446 break;
2447 }
2448 }
2449 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002450 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002451 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2452 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002453 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002454 if (GDecl)
2455 return GDecl;
2456 }
2457 }
2458 return GDecl;
2459}
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002460
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002461Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002462Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseType,
2463 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002464 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2465 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2466 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2467 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2468 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
2469
2470 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2471 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2472 //
2473 // T* t;
2474 // t.f;
2475 //
2476 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2477 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2478 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2479 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002480 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002481 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2482 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002483 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002484 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002485 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002486 return ExprError();
2487 }
2488 }
2489
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002490 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002491 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002492
2493 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2494 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002495 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002496 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2497 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep()),
2498 SS.getRange(),
2499 FirstQualifierInScope,
2500 Name, NameLoc,
2501 TemplateArgs));
2502}
2503
2504/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2505/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2506/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2507static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2508 Expr *BaseExpr,
2509 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002510 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002511 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002512 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2513 // diagnostics.
2514 if (!BaseExpr)
2515 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002516
John McCall1e67dd62010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002517 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2518 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002519}
2520
2521// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2522// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2523// type. The restriction here is:
2524//
2525// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2526// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2527// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2528//
2529// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2530// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2531// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2532// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2533bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2534 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002535 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002536 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002537 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2538 if (!BaseRT) {
2539 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2540 // dependent.
2541 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2542 return false;
2543 }
2544 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002545
2546 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002547 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2548 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002549 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002550 return false;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002551
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002552 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
2553 CXXRecordDecl *RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>((*I)->getDeclContext());
2554 while (RecordD->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
2555 RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordD->getParent());
2556
2557 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
2558 MemberRecord.insert(RecordD->getCanonicalDecl());
2559
2560 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2561 return false;
2562 }
2563
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002564 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002565 return true;
2566}
2567
2568static bool
2569LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2570 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002571 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002572 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2573 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002574 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002575 << BaseRange))
2576 return true;
2577
2578 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2579 if (SS.isSet()) {
2580 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2581 // nested-name-specifier.
2582 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2583
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002584 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS)) {
2585 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2586 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2587 return true;
2588 }
2589
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002590 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002591
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002592 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2593 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2594 << DC << SS.getRange();
2595 return true;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002596 }
2597 }
2598
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002599 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2600 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002601
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002602 if (!R.empty())
2603 return false;
2604
2605 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2606 // for typos.
2607 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002608 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002609 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002610 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2611 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2612 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002613 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2614 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002615 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2616 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2617 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002618 return false;
2619 } else {
2620 R.clear();
2621 }
2622
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002623 return false;
2624}
2625
2626Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002627Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg BaseArg, QualType BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002628 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002629 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002630 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2631 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2632 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2633 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
2634
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002635 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2636 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002637 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002638 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2639 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2640 Name, NameLoc,
2641 TemplateArgs);
2642
2643 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002644
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002645 // Implicit member accesses.
2646 if (!Base) {
2647 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2648 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2649 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2650 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
2651 OpLoc, SS))
2652 return ExprError();
2653
2654 // Explicit member accesses.
2655 } else {
2656 OwningExprResult Result =
2657 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002658 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ DeclPtrTy());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002659
2660 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2661 Owned(Base);
2662 return ExprError();
2663 }
2664
2665 if (Result.get())
2666 return move(Result);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002667 }
2668
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002669 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002670 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2671 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002672}
2673
2674Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002675Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseExprType,
2676 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2677 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002678 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002679 LookupResult &R,
2680 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2681 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002682 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002683 if (IsArrow) {
2684 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2685 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2686 }
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002687 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002688
2689 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier =
2690 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep());
2691 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2692 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
2693
2694 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002695 return ExprError();
2696
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002697 if (R.empty()) {
2698 // Rederive where we looked up.
2699 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2700 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2701 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002702
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002703 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002704 << MemberName << DC
2705 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002706 return ExprError();
2707 }
2708
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002709 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2710 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2711 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2712 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2713 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2714 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2715 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2716 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2717 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2718 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
2719 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002720 return ExprError();
2721
2722 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2723 // result.
2724 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002725 bool Dependent =
John McCall71739032009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002726 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002727 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002728 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002729
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002730 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2731 // pick a member.
2732 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2733
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002734 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2735 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2736 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002737 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2738 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002739 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
2740 MemberName, MemberLoc,
2741 TemplateArgs);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002742 MemExpr->addDecls(R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002743
2744 return Owned(MemExpr);
2745 }
2746
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002747 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002748 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002749 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2750
2751 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2752
2753 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2754 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2755 // error cases.
2756 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2757 return ExprError();
2758
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002759 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2760 if (!BaseExpr) {
2761 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002762 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002763 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), MemberDecl);
2764
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002765 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2766 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2767 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2768 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002769 }
2770
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002771 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2772 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2773 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2774 // explicitly qualified.
2775 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2776 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2777 }
2778
2779 // Check the use of this member.
2780 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2781 Owned(BaseExpr);
2782 return ExprError();
2783 }
2784
2785 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2786 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2787 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman78cde142009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002788 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2789 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002790 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2791 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2792
2793 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2794 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2795 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2796 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2797 else {
2798 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2799 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2800 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2801
2802 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2803 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2804
2805 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2806 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2807 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2808 }
2809
2810 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002811 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002812 return ExprError();
2813 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002814 FD, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, MemberType));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002815 }
2816
2817 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2818 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2819 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002820 Var, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002821 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2822 }
2823
2824 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2825 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2826 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002827 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002828 MemberFn->getType()));
2829 }
2830
2831 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2832 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2833 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002834 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, Enum->getType()));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002835 }
2836
2837 Owned(BaseExpr);
2838
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002839 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002840 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002841 Diag(MemberLoc,diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
2842 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2843 else
2844 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2845 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002846
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002847 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2848 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002849 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002850 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002851}
2852
2853/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2854/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2855/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2856/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2857/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2858/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2859/// an ordinary member expression.
2860///
2861/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2862/// fixed for ObjC++.
2863Sema::OwningExprResult
2864Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00002865 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002866 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002867 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00002868 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002869
Steve Naroffeaaae462007-12-16 21:42:28 +00002870 // Perform default conversions.
2871 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002872
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002873 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002874 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
2875
2876 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2877 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002878
2879 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002880 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002881 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
2882 // call, and continue on.
2883 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2884 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
2885 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
2886 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
2887 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002888 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
2889 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002890 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
2891 ->isRecordType()))) {
2892 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
2893 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
2894 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002895 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002896
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002897 OwningExprResult NewBase
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002898 = ActOnCallExpr(0, ExprArg(*this, BaseExpr), Loc,
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002899 MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), 0, Loc);
2900 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002901 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002902
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002903 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
2904 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
2905 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
2906 }
2907 }
2908 }
2909
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002910 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2911 // use that.
2912 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002913 if (IsArrow) {
2914 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
2915 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
2916 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
2917 if (OPT->getPointeeType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ObjCId) &&
2918 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00002919 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
2920 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002921 }
2922 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002923 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2924 // is a reference to 'isa'.
2925 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
2926 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002927 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002928 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002929 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002930
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00002931 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2932 // use that.
2933 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
2934 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2935 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
2936 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
2937 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
2938 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
2939 }
2940 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002941
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002942 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002943
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002944 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002945 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002946 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
2947 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
2948 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
2949 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
2950 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
2951 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
2952 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
2953 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
2954 // Check the use of this method.
2955 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
2956 return ExprError();
2957 }
2958 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
2959 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
2960 Selector SetterSel =
2961 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
2962 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
2963 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
2964 if (!Setter) {
2965 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
2966 // methods.
Steve Naroffbb69c942009-10-01 23:46:04 +00002967 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002968 }
2969 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
2970 if (!Setter)
2971 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002972
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002973 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
2974 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002975
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002976 if (Getter || Setter) {
2977 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002978
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002979 if (Getter)
2980 PType = Getter->getResultType();
2981 else
2982 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
2983 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
2984 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002985 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002986 PType,
2987 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
2988 }
2989 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
2990 << MemberName << BaseType);
2991 }
2992 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002993
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002994 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
2995 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
2996 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002997 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002998 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002999
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003000 if (IsArrow) {
3001 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003002 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003003 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3004 ;
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003005 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3006 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3007 // struct MyRecord foo;
3008 // foo->bar
3009 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3010 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3011 // by now.
3012 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3013 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003014 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003015 IsArrow = false;
3016 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003017 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3018 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3019 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson524d5a42009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003020 }
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003021 } else {
3022 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3023 // type *foo;
3024 // foo.bar
3025 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3026 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3027 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3028 // the appropriate pointer type
3029 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3030 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3031 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3032 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3033 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003034 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003035 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3036 IsArrow = true;
3037 }
3038 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003039 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003040
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003041 // Handle field access to simple records. This also handles access
3042 // to fields of the ObjC 'id' struct.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003043 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003044 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
3045 RTy, OpLoc, SS))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003046 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003047 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003048 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003049
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003050 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3051 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003052 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
3053 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCInterfaceType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003054 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003055 const ObjCInterfaceType *IFaceT =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003056 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceType() : BaseType->getAs<ObjCInterfaceType>();
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003057 if (IFaceT) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003058 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3059
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003060 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = IFaceT->getDecl();
3061 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003062 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003063
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003064 if (!IV) {
3065 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3066 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3067 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003068 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003069 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003070 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003071 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3072 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003073 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3074 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003075 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003076 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003077 }
3078 }
3079
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003080 if (IV) {
3081 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3082 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3083 // error cases.
3084 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3085 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003086
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003087 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3088 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3089 return ExprError();
3090 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3091 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3092 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3093 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3094 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3095 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3096 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3097 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3098 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3099 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3100 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3101 // AST for a function decl.
3102 Decl *ImplDecl = ObjCImpDecl.getAs<Decl>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003103 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003104 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ImplDecl))
3105 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3106 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
3107 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ImplDecl))
3108 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3109 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003110
3111 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3112 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003113 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003114 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003115 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003116 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3117 // @protected
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003118 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003119 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffd1b64be2009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003120 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003121
3122 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3123 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003124 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahaniana458c4f2009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003125 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003126 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003127 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003128 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianb1378f92008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003129 }
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003130 }
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003131 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003132 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3133 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003134 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003135 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003136
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003137 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003138 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003139 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3140 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3141 // Check the use of this declaration
3142 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3143 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003144
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003145 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3146 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3147 }
3148 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3149 // Check the use of this method.
3150 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3151 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003152
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003153 return Owned(ObjCMessageExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor9a129192010-04-21 00:45:42 +00003154 OMD->getResultType().getNonReferenceType(),
3155 OpLoc, BaseExpr, Sel,
3156 OMD, NULL, 0, MemberLoc));
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003157 }
3158 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003159
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003160 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003161 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003162 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003163
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003164 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3165 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner2b1ca5f2010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003166 if (!IsArrow)
3167 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3168 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattner90c58fa2010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003169 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003170
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003171 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003172 if (!IsArrow &&
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003173 BaseType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ObjCId) &&
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003174 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003175 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003176 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003177
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003178 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner6c7ce102009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003179 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003180 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003181 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3182 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003183 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003184 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003185 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003186 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003187
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003188 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3189 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3190
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003191 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003192}
3193
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003194/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3195/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3196/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3197/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3198/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3199///
3200/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3201/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3202/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3203/// only be called
3204/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3205/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3206/// aren't properly put in the context chain
3207Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg BaseArg,
3208 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3209 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003210 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003211 UnqualifiedId &Id,
3212 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl,
3213 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3214 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3215 return ExprError();
3216
3217 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3218
3219 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
3220 DeclarationName Name;
3221 SourceLocation NameLoc;
3222 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3223 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
3224 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
3225
3226 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3227
3228 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3229 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3230 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3231
3232 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
3233 BaseArg = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(BaseArg));
3234
3235 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
3236 OwningExprResult Result(*this);
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003237 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3238 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003239 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003240 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3241 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3242 Name, NameLoc,
3243 TemplateArgs);
3244 } else {
3245 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
3246 if (TemplateArgs) {
3247 // Re-use the lookup done for the template name.
3248 DecomposeTemplateName(R, Id);
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003249
Douglas Gregor9262f472010-04-27 18:19:34 +00003250 // Re-derive the naming class.
3251 if (SS.isSet()) {
3252 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier
3253 = static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier *>(SS.getScopeRep());
3254 if (const Type *Ty = Qualifier->getAsType())
3255 if (CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
3256 R.setNamingClass(NamingClass);
3257 } else {
3258 QualType BaseType = Base->getType();
3259 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
3260 BaseType = Ptr->getPointeeType();
3261 if (CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = BaseType->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
3262 R.setNamingClass(NamingClass);
3263 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003264 } else {
3265 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003266 SS, ObjCImpDecl);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003267
3268 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3269 Owned(Base);
3270 return ExprError();
3271 }
3272
3273 if (Result.get()) {
3274 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3275 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3276 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3277 // call now.
3278 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3279 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
Douglas Gregor0d5b0a12010-02-24 21:29:12 +00003280 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameLoc, move(Result));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003281
3282 return move(Result);
3283 }
3284 }
3285
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003286 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003287 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3288 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003289 }
3290
3291 return move(Result);
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003292}
3293
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003294Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3295 FunctionDecl *FD,
3296 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3297 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
3298 Diag (CallLoc,
3299 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3300 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003301 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003302 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
3303 } else {
3304 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3305 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
3306
3307 // Instantiate the expression.
Douglas Gregor8c702532010-02-05 07:33:43 +00003308 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3309 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson657bad42009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003310
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003311 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param,
3312 ArgList.getInnermost().getFlatArgumentList(),
Douglas Gregor01afeef2009-08-28 20:31:08 +00003313 ArgList.getInnermost().flat_size());
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003314
John McCall76d824f2009-08-25 22:02:44 +00003315 OwningExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003316 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003317 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003318
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003319 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3320 InitializedEntity Entity
3321 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param);
3322 InitializationKind Kind
3323 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3324 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3325 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
3326
3327 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003328 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003329 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&ResultE, 1));
3330 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003331 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003332
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003333 // Build the default argument expression.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003334 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003335 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003336 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003337
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003338 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3339 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3340 // be properly destroyed.
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003341 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3342 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Anders Carlsson714d0962009-12-15 19:16:31 +00003343 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i)
3344 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003345 }
3346
3347 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003348 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003349}
3350
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003351/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3352/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3353/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3354/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3355/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3356/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003357bool
3358Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003359 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003360 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003361 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3362 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003363 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003364 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3365 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003366 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003367
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003368 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3369 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3370 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3371 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3372 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003373 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherabf1e182010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003374 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003375 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003376 }
3377
3378 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3379 // them.
3380 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3381 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3382 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3383 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003384 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopher2a5aaff2010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003385 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003386 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3387 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3388 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003389 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003390 return true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003391 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003392 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003393 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003394 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003395 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3396 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3397 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3398 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3399 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003400 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian4fa66ce2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003401 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003402 if (Invalid)
3403 return true;
3404 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3405 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3406 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003407
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003408 return false;
3409}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003410
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003411bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3412 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3413 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3414 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3415 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3416 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003417 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003418 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3419 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3420 bool Invalid = false;
3421 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3422 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3423 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3424 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003425 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003426 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003427 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003428
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003429 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003430 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3431 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003432
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003433 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3434 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003435 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003436 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003437 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003438
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003439 // Pass the argument
3440 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3441 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3442 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregor96596c92009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003443
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003444
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003445 InitializedEntity Entity =
3446 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param)
3447 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(ProtoArgType);
3448 OwningExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
3449 SourceLocation(),
3450 Owned(Arg));
3451 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3452 return true;
3453
3454 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003455 } else {
Anders Carlssonc80a1272009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003456 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003457
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003458 OwningExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003459 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003460 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3461 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003462
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003463 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003464 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003465 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003466 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003467
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003468 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003469 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003470 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003471 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i < NumArgs; i++) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003472 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00003473 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003474 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003475 }
3476 }
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003477 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003478}
3479
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003480/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003481/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3482/// locations.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003483Action::OwningExprResult
3484Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3485 MultiExprArg args,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003486 SourceLocation *CommaLocs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003487 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003488
3489 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
3490 fn = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(fn));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003491
Anders Carlsson3cbc8592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00003492 Expr *Fn = fn.takeAs<Expr>();
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003493 Expr **Args = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(args.release());
Chris Lattner38dbdb22007-07-21 03:03:59 +00003494 assert(Fn && "no function call expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003495
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003496 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003497 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3498 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3499 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3500 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3501 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003502 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003503 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3504 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003505
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003506 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3507 Args[I]->Destroy(Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003508
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003509 NumArgs = 0;
3510 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003511
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003512 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3513 RParenLoc));
3514 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003515
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003516 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003517 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003518 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3519 // Fn.
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003520 bool Dependent = false;
3521 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3522 Dependent = true;
3523 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3524 Dependent = true;
3525
3526 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003527 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003528 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3529
3530 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3531 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3532 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3533 CommaLocs, RParenLoc));
3534
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003535 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3536
3537 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3538 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3539 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3540 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3541 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3542 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3543 // method template.
3544 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003545 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3546 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor8f184a32009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003547 (void)MemE;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003548
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003549 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3550 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003551 }
3552
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003553 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003554 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003555 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003556 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003557 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3558 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003559 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003560
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003561 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003562 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003563 if (BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemD ||
3564 BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003565 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT =
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003566 dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(BO->getType())) {
3567 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getResultType().getNonReferenceType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003568
3569 ExprOwningPtr<CXXMemberCallExpr>
3570 TheCall(this, new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003571 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3572 RParenLoc));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003573
3574 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3575 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003576 TheCall.get(), 0))
3577 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson63dce022009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003578
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003579 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003580 RParenLoc))
3581 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003582
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003583 return Owned(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.release()).release());
3584 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003585 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003586 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3587 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003588 }
3589 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003590 }
3591
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003592 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003593 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003594 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003595
Eli Friedmane14b1992009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003596 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003597 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3598 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003599 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003600 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003601 }
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003602
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003603 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3604 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3605 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3606
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003607 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3608}
3609
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003610/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3611/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003612/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3613/// block-pointer type.
3614///
3615/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
3616Sema::OwningExprResult
3617Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3618 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3619 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3620 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3621 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3622
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003623 // Promote the function operand.
3624 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3625
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003626 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3627 // of arguments and function on error.
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003628 ExprOwningPtr<CallExpr> TheCall(this, new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3629 Args, NumArgs,
3630 Context.BoolTy,
3631 RParenLoc));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003632
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003633 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3634 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3635 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3636 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003637 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003638 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003639 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3640 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003641 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003642 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003643 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003644 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003645 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003646 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003647 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3648 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3649
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003650 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003651 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003652 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall.get(),
3653 FDecl))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003654 return ExprError();
3655
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003656 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +00003657 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getResultType().getNonReferenceType());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003658
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003659 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003660 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003661 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003662 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003663 } else {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003664 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003665
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003666 if (FDecl) {
3667 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3668 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3669 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisddcd1322009-06-30 02:35:26 +00003670 if (FDecl->getBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003671 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003672 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003673 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3674 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3675 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3676 }
3677 }
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003678 }
3679
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003680 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003681 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3682 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3683 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003684 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3685 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003686 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3687 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003688 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003689 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003690 }
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00003691 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003692
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003693 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3694 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003695 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3696 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003697
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003698 // Check for sentinels
3699 if (NDecl)
3700 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003701
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003702 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003703 if (FDecl) {
3704 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall.get()))
3705 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003706
Douglas Gregor15fc9562009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003707 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003708 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall.take());
3709 } else if (NDecl) {
3710 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall.get()))
3711 return ExprError();
3712 }
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003713
Anders Carlssonf8984012009-08-16 03:06:32 +00003714 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.take());
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003715}
3716
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003717Action::OwningExprResult
3718Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
3719 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003720 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroff57eb2c52007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003721 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003722 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003723
3724 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3725 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3726 if (!TInfo)
3727 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3728
3729 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(InitExpr));
3730}
3731
3732Action::OwningExprResult
3733Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
3734 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
3735 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003736 Expr *literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(InitExpr.get());
Anders Carlsson2c1ec6d2007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003737
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003738 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003739 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003740 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3741 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor1c37d9e2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003742 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3743 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003744 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003745 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003746 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003747 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003748
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003749 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregor1b303932009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003750 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003751 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003752 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003753 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003754 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
3755 OwningExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3756 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&literalExpr, 1),
3757 &literalType);
3758 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003759 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003760 InitExpr.release();
3761 literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Result.get());
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003762
Chris Lattner79413952008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003763 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003764 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003765 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003766 return ExprError();
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003767 }
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003768
3769 Result.release();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003770
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003771 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003772 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003773}
3774
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003775Action::OwningExprResult
3776Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003777 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3778 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
3779 Expr **InitList = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(initlist.release());
Anders Carlsson4692db02007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003780
Steve Naroff30d242c2007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003781 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003782 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003783
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003784 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3785 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003786 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003787 return Owned(E);
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003788}
3789
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003790static CastExpr::CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
3791 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003792 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003793 return CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
3794
3795 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3796 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003797 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
3798 CastExpr::CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
Fariborz Jahanian2b9fc832009-12-15 21:34:52 +00003799 CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003800 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3801 return CastExpr::CK_PointerToIntegral;
3802 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003803
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003804 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3805 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3806 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast;
3807 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
3808 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer;
3809 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3810 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToFloating;
3811 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003812
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003813 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3814 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3815 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast;
3816 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3817 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingToIntegral;
3818 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003819
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003820 // FIXME: Assert here.
3821 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
3822 return CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
3823}
3824
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003825/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redl955a0672009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003826bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003827 CastExpr::CastKind& Kind,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003828 CXXBaseSpecifierArray &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahanian1cec0c42009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003829 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003830 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003831 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3832 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003833
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003834 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003835
3836 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3837 // type needs to be scalar.
3838 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3839 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003840 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToVoid;
3841 return false;
3842 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003843
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003844 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003845 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003846 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3847 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003848 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003849 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3850 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonec143772009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003851 Kind = CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003852 return false;
3853 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003854
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003855 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003856 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003857 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003858 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003859 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003860 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003861 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003862 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003863 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3864 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3865 break;
3866 }
3867 }
3868 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3869 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3870 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonec143772009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003871 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003872 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003873 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003874
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003875 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
3876 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
3877 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3878 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003879
3880 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003881 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003882 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3883 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003884 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003885 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003886
3887 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003888 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003889
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003890 if (castType->isVectorType())
3891 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
3892 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
3893 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
3894
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003895 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
3896 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003897
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003898 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003899 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
3900 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType() && castExprType->isArithmeticType())
3901 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3902 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
3903 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3904 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
3905 if (!castType->isIntegralType() && castType->isArithmeticType())
3906 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3907 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
3908 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003909 }
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003910
3911 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003912 return false;
3913}
3914
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003915bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
3916 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003917 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003918
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003919 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00003920 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003921 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003922 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003923 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003924 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003925 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003926 } else
3927 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003928 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003929 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003930
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003931 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003932 return false;
3933}
3934
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003935bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003936 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003937 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003938
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003939 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003940
Nate Begemanc8961a42009-06-27 22:05:55 +00003941 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
3942 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003943 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
3944 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
3945 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
3946 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003947 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003948 return false;
3949 }
3950
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00003951 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003952 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
3953 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00003954 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
3955 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
3956 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
3957 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003958
3959 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
3960 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
3961 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003962
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003963 Kind = CastExpr::CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003964 return false;
3965}
3966
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003967Action::OwningExprResult
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003968Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003969 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
3970 assert((Ty != 0) && (Op.get() != 0) &&
3971 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff1a2cf6b2007-07-16 23:25:18 +00003972
John McCall97513962010-01-15 18:39:57 +00003973 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
3974 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
3975 if (!castTInfo)
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003976 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003977
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003978 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003979 Expr *castExpr = (Expr *)Op.get();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003980 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003981 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, move(Op),
3982 castTInfo);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003983
3984 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
3985}
3986
3987Action::OwningExprResult
3988Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
3989 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
3990 Expr *castExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Op.get());
3991
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003992 CastExpr::CastKind Kind = CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson5d270e82010-04-24 18:38:56 +00003993 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003994 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003995 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003996 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssone9766d52009-09-09 21:33:21 +00003997
Douglas Gregorb33eed02010-04-16 22:09:46 +00003998 Op.release();
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003999 return Owned(new (Context) CStyleCastExpr(Ty->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
Anders Carlsson5d270e82010-04-24 18:38:56 +00004000 Kind, castExpr, BasePath, Ty,
Anders Carlssonf10e4142009-08-07 22:21:05 +00004001 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004002}
4003
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004004/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4005/// of comma binary operators.
4006Action::OwningExprResult
4007Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg EA) {
4008 Expr *expr = EA.takeAs<Expr>();
4009 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4010 if (!E)
4011 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004012
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004013 OwningExprResult Result(*this, E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004014
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004015 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
4016 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, move(Result),
4017 Owned(E->getExpr(i)));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004018
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004019 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), move(Result));
4020}
4021
4022Action::OwningExprResult
4023Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4024 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004025 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004026 ParenListExpr *PE = (ParenListExpr *)Op.get();
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004027 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004028
4029 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004030 // then handle it as such.
4031 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4032 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4033 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4034 return ExprError();
4035 }
4036
4037 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4038 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4039 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4040
4041 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4042 // braces instead of the original commas.
4043 Op.release();
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004044 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4045 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004046 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4047 E->setType(Ty);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004048 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Owned(E));
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004049 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004050 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004051 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
4052 Op = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Op));
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004053 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004054 }
4055}
4056
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004057Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004058 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004059 MultiExprArg Val,
4060 TypeTy *TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004061 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4062 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004063 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4064 Expr *expr;
4065 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4066 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4067 else
4068 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004069 return Owned(expr);
4070}
4071
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004072/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4073/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004074/// C99 6.5.15
4075QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4076 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004077 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4078 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
4079 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
4080
John McCall71d8d9b2010-03-11 19:43:18 +00004081 CheckSignCompare(LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
John McCall1fa36b72009-11-05 09:23:39 +00004082
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004083 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
4084 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
4085 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4086 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4087 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4088 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004089
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004090 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004091 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
4092 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4093 << CondTy;
4094 return QualType();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004095 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004096
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004097 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004098 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4099 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004100
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004101 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4102 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004103 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4104 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4105 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004106 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004107
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004108 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4109 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004110 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4111 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004112 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004113 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004114 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004115 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004116 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004117 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004118
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004119 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004120 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004121 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4122 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4123 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4124 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4125 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4126 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4127 << LHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004128 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
4129 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman3e1852f2008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004130 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004131 }
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004132 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4133 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004134 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004135 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004136 // promote the null to a pointer.
4137 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004138 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004139 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004140 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004141 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004142 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004143 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004144 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004145
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004146 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4147 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4148 QuestionLoc);
4149 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4150 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004151
4152
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004153 // Handle block pointer types.
4154 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4155 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4156 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4157 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004158 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4159 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004160 return destType;
4161 }
4162 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004163 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004164 return QualType();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004165 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004166 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4167 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4168 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004169 return LHSTy;
4170 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004171 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004172 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4173 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004174
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004175 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4176 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004177 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004178 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004179 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4180 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4181 // to get a consistent AST.
4182 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004183 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4184 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004185 return incompatTy;
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004186 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004187 // The block pointer types are compatible.
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004188 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4189 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroffea4c7802009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004190 return LHSTy;
4191 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004192
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004193 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4194 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4195 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004196 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4197 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004198
4199 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4200 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4201 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004202 QualType destPointee
4203 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004204 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004205 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4206 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4207 // Promote to void*.
4208 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004209 return destType;
4210 }
4211 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004212 QualType destPointee
4213 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004214 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004215 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
Eli Friedmanb0bc5592009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004216 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004217 // Promote to void*.
Eli Friedmanb0bc5592009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004218 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004219 return destType;
4220 }
4221
4222 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4223 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4224 return LHSTy;
4225 }
4226 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4227 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4228 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4229 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4230 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4231 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4232 // to get a consistent AST.
4233 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004234 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4235 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004236 return incompatTy;
4237 }
4238 // The pointer types are compatible.
4239 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4240 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4241 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4242 // type.
4243 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4244 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004245 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4246 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004247 return LHSTy;
4248 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004249
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004250 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4251 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4252 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4253 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004254 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004255 return RHSTy;
4256 }
4257 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4258 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4259 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004260 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004261 return LHSTy;
4262 }
Daniel Dunbar484603b2008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004263
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004264 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004265 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4266 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004267 return QualType();
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004268}
4269
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004270/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4271/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4272QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4273 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4274 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4275 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004276
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004277 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4278 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4279 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4280 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4281 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4282 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4283 return LHSTy;
4284 }
4285 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4286 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4287 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4288 return RHSTy;
4289 }
4290 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4291 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4292 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4293 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4294 return LHSTy;
4295 }
4296 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4297 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4298 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4299 return RHSTy;
4300 }
4301 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4302 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4303 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4304 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4305 return LHSTy;
4306 }
4307 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4308 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4309 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4310 return RHSTy;
4311 }
4312 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4313 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004314
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004315 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4316 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4317 return LHSTy;
4318 }
4319 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4320 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4321 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004322
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004323 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4324 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4325 // type. This allows
4326 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4327 // where B is a subclass of A.
4328 //
4329 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4330 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4331 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4332 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004333
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004334 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4335 // It could return the composite type.
4336 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4337 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4338 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4339 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4340 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4341 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4342 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4343 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4344 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4345 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4346 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4347 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4348 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4349 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004350 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004351 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4352 ;
4353 else {
4354 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4355 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4356 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4357 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
4358 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4359 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4360 return incompatTy;
4361 }
4362 // The object pointer types are compatible.
4363 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4364 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4365 return compositeType;
4366 }
4367 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4368 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4369 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4370 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4371 QualType destPointee
4372 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4373 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4374 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4375 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4376 // Promote to void*.
4377 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4378 return destType;
4379 }
4380 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4381 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4382 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4383 QualType destPointee
4384 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4385 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4386 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4387 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4388 // Promote to void*.
4389 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4390 return destType;
4391 }
4392 return QualType();
4393}
4394
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004395/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004396/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004397Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
4398 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
4399 ExprArg Cond, ExprArg LHS,
4400 ExprArg RHS) {
4401 Expr *CondExpr = (Expr *) Cond.get();
4402 Expr *LHSExpr = (Expr *) LHS.get(), *RHSExpr = (Expr *) RHS.get();
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004403
4404 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4405 // was the condition.
4406 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
4407 if (isLHSNull)
4408 LHSExpr = CondExpr;
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004409
4410 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr,
Chris Lattnerdaaa9f22007-07-16 21:39:03 +00004411 RHSExpr, QuestionLoc);
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004412 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004413 return ExprError();
4414
4415 Cond.release();
4416 LHS.release();
4417 RHS.release();
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004418 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00004419 isLHSNull ? 0 : LHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004420 ColonLoc, RHSExpr, result));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004421}
4422
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004423// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004424// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004425// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4426// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4427// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004428Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004429Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004430 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004431
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004432 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4433 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4434 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4435 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4436 return Compatible;
4437 }
4438
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004439 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004440 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4441 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004442
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004443 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004444 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4445 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004446
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004447 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004448
4449 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4450 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4451 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianece85822009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004452 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004453 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004454 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004455
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004456 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4457 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004458 // version of void...
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004459 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004460 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004461 return ConvTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004462
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004463 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004464 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4465 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004466 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004467
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004468 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004469 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004470 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004471
4472 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004473 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4474 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004475 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004476 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004477 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004478 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4479 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4480 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4481 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4482 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4483 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004484 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004485 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004486 else if (lhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004487 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004488
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004489 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004490 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004491 else if (rhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004492 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004493
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004494 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4495 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4496 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4497 // warning can be disabled.
4498 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4499 return ConvTy;
4500 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4501 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004502
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004503 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4504 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4505 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4506 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4507 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4508 do {
4509 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4510 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004511
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004512 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4513 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4514 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004515
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004516 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004517 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004518 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004519
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004520 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004521 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004522 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004523 return ConvTy;
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004524}
4525
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004526/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4527/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4528/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4529// types.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004530Sema::AssignConvertType
4531Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004532 QualType rhsType) {
4533 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004534
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004535 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004536 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4537 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004538
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004539 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4540 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4541 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004542
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004543 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004544
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004545 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004546 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004547 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004548
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004549 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4550 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4551 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4552 }
4553 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004554 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004555 return ConvTy;
4556}
4557
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004558/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4559/// for assignment compatibility.
4560Sema::AssignConvertType
4561Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004562 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4563 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004564 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4565 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004566 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004567 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004568 }
4569 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4570 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004571 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4572 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004573 return IncompatiblePointer;
4574 return Compatible;
4575 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004576 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004577 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004578 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004579 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4580 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4581 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4582 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4583 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4584 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004585
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004586 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4587 return Compatible;
4588 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4589 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004590 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004591}
4592
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004593/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4594/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004595/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4596///
4597/// int a, *pint;
4598/// short *pshort;
4599/// struct foo *pfoo;
4600///
4601/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4602/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4603/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4604/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4605///
4606/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004607/// C99 spec dictates.
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004608///
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004609Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004610Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004611 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4612 // them.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004613 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4614 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004615
4616 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerf5c973d2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004617 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff44fd8ff2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004618
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004619 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4620 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4621 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4622 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4623 return Compatible;
4624 }
4625
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004626 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4627 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4628 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4629 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4630 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4631 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4632 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004633 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004634 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson24ebce62007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004635 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004636 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahaniana1e34202007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004637 }
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004638 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4639 // to the same ExtVector type.
4640 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4641 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4642 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
4643 if (!rhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType())
4644 return Compatible;
4645 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004646
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004647 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004648 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004649 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004650 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004651 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4652 lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004653 if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType))
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004654 return IncompatibleVectors;
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004655 }
4656 return Incompatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004657 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004658
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004659 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004660 return Compatible;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004661
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004662 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004663 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004664 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004665
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004666 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004667 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004668
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004669 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004670 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004671 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4672 return Compatible;
4673 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004674 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004675 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4676 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004677 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004678
4679 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004680 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004681 return Compatible;
4682 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004683 return Incompatible;
4684 }
4685
4686 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4687 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedman8163b7a2009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004688 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004689
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004690 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004691 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004692 return Compatible;
4693
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004694 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4695 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004696
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004697 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004698 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004699 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004700 }
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004701 return Incompatible;
4702 }
4703
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004704 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4705 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4706 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004707
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004708 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004709 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004710 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4711 return Compatible;
4712 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004713 }
4714 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004715 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004716 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004717 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004718 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4719 return Compatible;
4720 }
4721 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4722 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4723 return Compatible;
4724 return Incompatible;
4725 }
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004726 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004727 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004728 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4729 return Compatible;
4730
4731 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004732 return PointerToInt;
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004733
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004734 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004735 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004736
4737 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004738 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004739 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004740 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004741 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004742 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4743 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4744 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4745 return Compatible;
4746
4747 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4748 return PointerToInt;
4749
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004750 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004751 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004752 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4753 return Compatible;
4754 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004755 }
4756 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004757 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004758 return Compatible;
4759 return Incompatible;
4760 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004761
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004762 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004763 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004764 return Compatible;
Bill Wendling216423b2007-05-30 06:30:29 +00004765 }
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004766 return Incompatible;
Steve Naroff9eb24652007-05-02 21:58:15 +00004767}
4768
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004769/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4770/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004771static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004772 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4773 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4774 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004775 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenek013041e2010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004776 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004777 SourceLocation());
4778 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4779 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4780
4781 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4782 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004783 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004784 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004785 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004786}
4787
4788Sema::AssignConvertType
4789Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4790 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4791
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004792 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004793 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4794 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004795 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004796 return Incompatible;
4797
4798 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4799 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4800 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4801 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004802 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4803 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004804 it != itend; ++it) {
4805 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4806 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4807 // 1) void pointer
4808 // 2) null pointer constant
4809 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004810 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004811 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004812 InitField = *it;
4813 break;
4814 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004815
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004816 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004817 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004818 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004819 InitField = *it;
4820 break;
4821 }
4822 }
4823
4824 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
4825 == Compatible) {
4826 InitField = *it;
4827 break;
4828 }
4829 }
4830
4831 if (!InitField)
4832 return Incompatible;
4833
4834 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
4835 return Compatible;
4836}
4837
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004838Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004839Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004840 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4841 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
4842 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
4843 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
4844 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00004845 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00004846 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004847 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner0d5640c2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00004848 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004849 }
4850
4851 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
4852 // structures.
4853 }
4854
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004855 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
4856 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004857 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
4858 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004859 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004860 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004861 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004862 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004863 return Compatible;
4864 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004865
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004866 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004867 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +00004868 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004869 // expressions that surpress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004870 //
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004871 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004872 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004873 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004874
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004875 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
4876 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004877
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004878 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
4879 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004880 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
4881 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
4882 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
4883 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004884 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004885 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonReferenceType(),
4886 CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004887 return result;
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004888}
4889
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004890QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004891 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00004892 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004893 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00004894 return QualType();
Steve Naroff6f49f5d2007-05-29 14:23:36 +00004895}
4896
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004897QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004898 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004899 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004900 QualType lhsType =
4901 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
4902 QualType rhsType =
4903 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004904
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004905 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004906 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00004907 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004908
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004909 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
4910 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004911 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
4912 // FIXME: Should we warn here?
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004913 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
4914 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004915 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004916 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004917 return lhsType->isExtVectorType() ? lhsType : rhsType;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004918 }
4919 }
4920 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004921
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004922 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
4923 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
4924 bool swapped = false;
4925 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4926 swapped = true;
4927 std::swap(rex, lex);
4928 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
4929 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004930
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00004931 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004932 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004933 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
4934 if (EltTy->isIntegralType() && rhsType->isIntegralType()) {
4935 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004936 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004937 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
4938 return lhsType;
4939 }
4940 }
4941 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
4942 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
4943 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004944 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004945 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
4946 return lhsType;
4947 }
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004948 }
4949 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004950
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00004951 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004952 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004953 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004954 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00004955 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00004956}
4957
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004958QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
4959 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar060d5e22009-01-05 22:42:10 +00004960 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004961 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004962
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00004963 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004964
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004965 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
4966 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
4967 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004968
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004969 // Check for division by zero.
4970 if (isDiv &&
4971 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004972 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00004973 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004974
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004975 return compType;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00004976}
4977
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004978QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004979 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00004980 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
4981 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
4982 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
4983 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
4984 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004985
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00004986 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004987
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004988 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
4989 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004990
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004991 // Check for remainder by zero.
4992 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00004993 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
4994 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004995
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004996 return compType;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00004997}
4998
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004999QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005000 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005001 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5002 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5003 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5004 return compType;
5005 }
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005006
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005007 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005008
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005009 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005010 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5011 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5012 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005013 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005014 }
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005015
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005016 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5017 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005018 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005019 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5020
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005021 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005022
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005023 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005024 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005025
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005026 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5027 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005028 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5029 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005030 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005031 return QualType();
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005032 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005033
5034 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5035 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5036 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005037 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005038 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5039 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5040 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5041 return QualType();
5042 }
5043
5044 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5045 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5046 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005047 } else {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005048 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005049 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005050 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005051 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5052 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005053 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5054 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005055 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005056 return QualType();
5057 }
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005058 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
5059 if (PointeeTy->isObjCInterfaceType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
5060 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5061 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5062 return QualType();
5063 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005064
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005065 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005066 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5067 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5068 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5069 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5070 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005071 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005072 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5073 }
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005074 return PExp->getType();
5075 }
5076 }
5077
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005078 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005079}
5080
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005081// C99 6.5.6
5082QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005083 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5084 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5085 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5086 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5087 return compType;
5088 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005089
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005090 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005091
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005092 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005093
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005094 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005095 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5096 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005097 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005098 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005099 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005100
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005101 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005102 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff4eed7a12009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005103 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005104
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005105 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005106
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005107 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5108 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5109 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5110 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5111 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5112 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5113 return QualType();
5114 }
5115
5116 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5117 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5118 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5119 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5120 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005121 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005122 return QualType();
5123 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005124
5125 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5126 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5127 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005128 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005129 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005130 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005131 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005132 return QualType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005133
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005134 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
5135 if (lpointee->isObjCInterfaceType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
5136 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5137 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5138 return QualType();
5139 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005140
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005141 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005142 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5143 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5144 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5145 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5146 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5147 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005148 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005149 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5150
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005151 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005152 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005153 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005154
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005155 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005156 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman1974e532008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005157 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005158
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005159 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5160 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5161 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5162 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5163 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5164 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5165 return QualType();
5166 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005167
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005168 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5169 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5170 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5171 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005172 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005173 return QualType();
5174 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005175
5176 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5177 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5178 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5179 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5180 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005181 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5182 << rex->getSourceRange()
5183 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005184 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005185
Eli Friedman168fe152009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005186 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5187 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5188 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5189 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5190 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5191 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5192 return QualType();
5193 }
5194 } else {
5195 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5196 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5197 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5198 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5199 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5200 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5201 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5202 return QualType();
5203 }
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005204 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005205
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005206 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5207 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5208 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5209 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5210 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005211 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005212 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005213
5214 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005215 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5216 }
5217 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005218
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005219 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005220}
5221
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005222// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005223QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005224 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005225 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
5226 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005227 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005228
Nate Begemane46ee9a2009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005229 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5230 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5231 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5232
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005233 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5234 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005235 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5236 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5237 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5238 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5239 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005240 }
Chris Lattner3c133402007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005241 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005242 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005243
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005244 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005245
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005246 // Sanity-check shift operands
5247 llvm::APSInt Right;
5248 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar687fa862009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005249 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5250 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn2f085712009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005251 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005252 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5253 else {
5254 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5255 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5256 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5257 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5258 }
5259 }
5260
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005261 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005262 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005263}
5264
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005265// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005266QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005267 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
5268 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)OpaqueOpc;
5269
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005270 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005271 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005272 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005273
John McCall71d8d9b2010-03-11 19:43:18 +00005274 CheckSignCompare(lex, rex, Loc, &Opc);
John McCall644a4182009-11-05 00:40:04 +00005275
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005276 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
Steve Naroff47fea352007-08-10 18:26:40 +00005277 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5278 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5279 else {
5280 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5281 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5282 }
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005283 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5284 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005285
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005286 if (!lType->isFloatingType()
5287 && !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational)) {
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005288 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5289 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5290 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005291 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparisons of enum constants. These can arise
Ted Kremenekde9e9682009-03-20 19:57:37 +00005292 // from macro expansions, and are usually quite deliberate.
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005293 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5294 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
5295 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped))
5296 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped))
Ted Kremenek9ffbe412009-03-20 18:35:45 +00005297 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
5298 !isa<EnumConstantDecl>(DRL->getDecl()))
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005299 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_selfcomparison));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005300
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005301 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5302 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5303 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5304 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005305
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005306 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5307 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005308 Expr *literalString = 0;
5309 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005310 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005311 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005312 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005313 literalString = lex;
5314 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005315 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5316 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005317 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005318 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005319 literalString = rex;
5320 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5321 }
5322
5323 if (literalString) {
5324 std::string resultComparison;
5325 switch (Opc) {
5326 case BinaryOperator::LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5327 case BinaryOperator::GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5328 case BinaryOperator::LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5329 case BinaryOperator::GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5330 case BinaryOperator::EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5331 case BinaryOperator::NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
5332 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5333 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005334
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005335 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5336 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5337 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek800b66b2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005338 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005339 }
Ted Kremeneke451eae2007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005340 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005341
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005342 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005343 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005344
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005345 if (isRelational) {
5346 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005347 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005348 } else {
Ted Kremeneke2763b02007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005349 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005350 if (lType->isFloatingType() && rType->isFloatingType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005351 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005352
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005353 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005354 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005355 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005356
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005357 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005358 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005359 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005360 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005361
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005362 // All of the following pointer related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5363 // when handling null pointer constants. One day, we can consider making them
5364 // errors (when -pedantic-errors is enabled).
Steve Naroff808eb8f2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005365 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005366 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005367 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005368 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005369 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005370
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005371 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005372 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5373 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005374 if (!isRelational &&
5375 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5376 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5377 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
5378 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5379 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5380 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5381 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5382 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5383 return ResultTy;
5384 }
5385 }
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005386 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5387 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5388 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5389 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5390 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5391 //
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005392 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005393 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005394 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005395 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005396 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005397 if (T.isNull()) {
5398 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5399 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5400 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005401 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005402 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005403 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005404 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005405 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005406 }
5407
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005408 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5409 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005410 return ResultTy;
5411 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005412 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5413 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5414 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5415 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5416 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5417 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5418 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5419 }
5420 } else if (!isRelational &&
5421 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5422 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5423 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5424 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5425 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5426 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5427 }
5428 } else {
5429 // Invalid
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005430 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005431 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff75c17232007-06-13 21:41:08 +00005432 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005433 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005434 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005435 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005436 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005437
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005438 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005439 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005440 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005441 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005442 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5443 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson83133d92009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005444 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005445 return ResultTy;
5446 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005447 if (LHSIsNull &&
5448 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5449 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson83133d92009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005450 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005451 return ResultTy;
5452 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005453
5454 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005455 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005456 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5457 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005458 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5459 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5460 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5461 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5462 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5463 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5464 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5465 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005466 // types.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005467 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005468 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005469 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005470 if (T.isNull()) {
5471 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005472 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005473 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005474 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005475 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005476 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005477 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005478 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005479 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005480
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005481 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5482 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005483 return ResultTy;
5484 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005485
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005486 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005487 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5488 return ResultTy;
5489 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005490
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005491 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005492 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005493 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5494 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005495
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005496 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedmana6638ca2009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005497 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005498 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005499 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005500 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005501 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005502 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005503 }
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005504 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005505 if (!isRelational
5506 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5507 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005508 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005509 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005510 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005511 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005512 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5513 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5514 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005515 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005516 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005517 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005518 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005519
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005520 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005521 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005522 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5523 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005524 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005525 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005526 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005527 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005528
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005529 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5530 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005531 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005532 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005533 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005534 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005535 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffea54d9e2008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005536 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005537 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005538 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005539 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5540 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005541 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005542 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffb788d9b2008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005543 }
Fariborz Jahanian134cbef2007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005544 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005545 if (lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005546 unsigned DiagID = 0;
5547 if (RHSIsNull) {
5548 if (isRelational)
5549 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
5550 } else if (isRelational)
5551 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5552 else
5553 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005554
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005555 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005556 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005557 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005558 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005559 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005560 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005561 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005562 if (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005563 unsigned DiagID = 0;
5564 if (LHSIsNull) {
5565 if (isRelational)
5566 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
5567 } else if (isRelational)
5568 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5569 else
5570 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005571
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005572 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005573 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005574 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005575 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005576 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005577 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00005578 }
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005579 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005580 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5581 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005582 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005583 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005584 }
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005585 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5586 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005587 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005588 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005589 }
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005590 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005591}
5592
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005593/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005594/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005595/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5596/// types.
5597QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005598 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005599 bool isRelational) {
5600 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5601 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005602 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005603 if (vType.isNull())
5604 return vType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005605
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005606 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5607 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005608
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005609 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5610 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5611 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
5612 if (!lType->isFloatingType()) {
5613 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5614 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5615 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005616 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_selfcomparison));
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005617 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005618
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005619 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
5620 if (!isRelational && lType->isFloatingType()) {
5621 assert (rType->isFloatingType());
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005622 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005623 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005624
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005625 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5626 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5627 // elements for floating point vectors.
5628 if (lType->isIntegerType())
5629 return lType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005630
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005631 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005632 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005633 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005634 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattner5d688962009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005635 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005636 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5637
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005638 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005639 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005640 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5641}
5642
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005643inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005644 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Steve Naroff94a5aca2007-07-16 22:23:01 +00005645 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005646 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005647
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005648 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005649
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005650 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005651 return compType;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005652 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005653}
5654
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005655inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005656 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc) {
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005657 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5658 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5659 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005660
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005661 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5662 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005663
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005664 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005665 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005666
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005667 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5668 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
5669 // The operands are both implicitly converted to type bool (clause 4).
5670 StandardConversionSequence LHS;
5671 if (!IsStandardConversion(lex, Context.BoolTy,
5672 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, LHS))
5673 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005674
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005675 if (PerformImplicitConversion(lex, Context.BoolTy, LHS,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005676 AA_Passing, /*IgnoreBaseAccess=*/false))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005677 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005678
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005679 StandardConversionSequence RHS;
5680 if (!IsStandardConversion(rex, Context.BoolTy,
5681 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, RHS))
5682 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005683
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005684 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rex, Context.BoolTy, RHS,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005685 AA_Passing, /*IgnoreBaseAccess=*/false))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005686 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005687
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005688 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5689 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5690 // The result is a bool.
5691 return Context.BoolTy;
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005692}
5693
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005694/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5695/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5696/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5697///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005698static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005699 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5700 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5701 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5702 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005703 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005704 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5705 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5706 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5707 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005708 }
5709 }
5710 return false;
5711}
5712
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005713/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5714/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5715static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005716 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005717 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005718 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005719 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5720 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005721 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5722 return false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005723
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005724 unsigned Diag = 0;
5725 bool NeedType = false;
5726 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005727 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005728 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005729 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5730 NeedType = true;
5731 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005732 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005733 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5734 NeedType = true;
5735 break;
Chris Lattner9b3bbe92008-11-17 19:51:54 +00005736 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005737 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
5738 break;
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005739 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
5740 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005741 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005742 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
5743 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005744 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5745 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005746 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
5747 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregored0cfbd2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00005748 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00005749 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00005750 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005751 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005752 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
5753 break;
Steve Naroffba756cb2008-09-26 14:41:28 +00005754 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005755 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5756 break;
Fariborz Jahanian8a1810f2008-11-22 18:39:36 +00005757 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
5758 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
5759 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5118c412008-11-22 20:25:50 +00005760 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
5761 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
5762 break;
Fariborz Jahaniane8d28902009-12-15 23:59:41 +00005763 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
5764 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
5765 break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005766 }
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00005767
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005768 SourceRange Assign;
5769 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
5770 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005771 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005772 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005773 else
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005774 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005775 return true;
5776}
5777
5778
5779
5780// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005781QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
5782 SourceLocation Loc,
5783 QualType CompoundType) {
5784 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
5785 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005786 return QualType();
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005787
5788 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
5789 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005790
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005791 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005792 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005793 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005794 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005795 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
5796 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
5797 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005798 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005799 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005800 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005801 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005802
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005803 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
5804 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
5805 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005806 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005807 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
5808 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
5809 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
5810 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ||
5811 UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Minus) &&
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005812 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005813 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005814 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
5815 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
5816 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattnered9f14c2009-03-09 07:11:10 +00005817 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
5818 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00005819 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
5820 << (UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ? "+" : "-")
5821 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005822 }
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005823 }
5824 } else {
5825 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedmanb05c41e2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00005826 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005827 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005828
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005829 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005830 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005831 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005832
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00005833 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
5834 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005835 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00005836 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
5837 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00005838 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005839 // operand.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005840 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005841}
5842
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005843// C99 6.5.17
5844QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattnerf6e1e302008-07-25 20:54:07 +00005845 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005846 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
5847 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
5848 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00005849
5850 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
5851 // incomplete in C++).
5852
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005853 return RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff95af0132007-03-30 23:47:58 +00005854}
5855
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005856/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
5857/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005858QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00005859 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00005860 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
5861 return Context.DependentTy;
5862
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005863 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
5864 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Steve Naroffd50c88e2007-04-05 21:15:20 +00005865
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005866 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
5867 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
5868 if (!isInc) {
5869 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5870 return QualType();
5871 }
5872 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
5873 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5874 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005875 // OK!
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005876 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
5877 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005878
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005879 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005880 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005881 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5882 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5883 << Op->getSourceRange();
5884 return QualType();
5885 }
5886
5887 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005888 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005889 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005890 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5891 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5892 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
5893 return QualType();
5894 }
5895
5896 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005897 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005898 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005899 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005900 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005901 << ResType))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005902 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00005903 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
5904 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCInterfaceType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
5905 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5906 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
5907 return QualType();
5908 }
Eli Friedman090addd2010-01-03 00:20:48 +00005909 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005910 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
5911 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005912 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005913 } else {
5914 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00005915 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005916 return QualType();
Steve Naroff46ba1eb2007-04-03 23:13:13 +00005917 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005918 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroff9e1e5512007-08-23 21:37:33 +00005919 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005920 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00005921 return QualType();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00005922 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
5923 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
5924 // operand.
5925 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
5926 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005927}
5928
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005929/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005930/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005931/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
5932/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
5933/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
5934/// - &(x) => x
5935/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
5936/// - &s.xx => s
5937/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
5938/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
5939/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
5940/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005941static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005942 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005943 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005944 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005945 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005946 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
5947 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
5948 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005949 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00005950 return 0;
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005951 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005952 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005953 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00005954 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
5955 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005956 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
5957 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
5958 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
5959 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
5960 }
5961 return 0;
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005962 }
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005963 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
5964 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005965
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005966 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005967 case UnaryOperator::Real:
5968 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
5969 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
5970 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
5971 default:
5972 return 0;
5973 }
5974 }
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005975 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005976 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00005977 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005978 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
5979 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005980 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005981 default:
5982 return 0;
5983 }
5984}
5985
5986/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005987/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005988/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005989/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00005990/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005991/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00005992/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00005993QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005994 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
5995 op = op->IgnoreParens();
5996
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00005997 if (op->isTypeDependent())
5998 return Context.DependentTy;
5999
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006000 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6001 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6002 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
6003 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Deref)
6004 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6005 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6006 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6007 }
6008 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6009 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6010 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006011 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner67315442008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006012 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes17f345f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006013
Sebastian Redl9a8dd0d2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006014 MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(op);
6015 if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction && ME &&
6016 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) {
6017 ValueDecl *dcl = cast<MemberExpr>(op)->getMemberDecl();
6018 // &f where f is a member of the current object, or &o.f, or &p->f
6019 // All these are not allowed, and we need to catch them before the dcl
6020 // branch of the if, below.
6021 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6022 << dcl;
6023 // FIXME: Improve this diagnostic and provide a fixit.
6024
6025 // Now recover by acting as if the function had been accessed qualified.
6026 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6027 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(dcl->getDeclContext()))
6028 .getTypePtr());
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006029 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
6030 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6031 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6032 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6033 if (isSFINAEContext())
6034 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl9a8dd0d2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006035 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006036 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006037 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006038 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006039 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006040 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6041 << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006042 return QualType();
6043 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006044 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006045 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6046 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6047 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006048 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson8abde4b2010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006049 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006050 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006051 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemana6b47a42009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006052 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006053 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian385db802009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006054 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6055 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6056 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6057 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6058 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson3fa58d12009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006059 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6060 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson01ccf992009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006061 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6062 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006063 } else if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(op)) {
6064 return Context.OverloadTy;
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006065 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006066 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006067 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6068 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006069 if (vd->getStorageClass() == VarDecl::Register) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006070 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6071 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006072 return QualType();
6073 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006074 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006075 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006076 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor9aa8b552008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006077 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006078 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6079 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006080 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006081 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006082 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6083 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006084 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006085 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6086 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6087 return QualType();
6088 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006089
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006090 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6091 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006092 }
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006093 }
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006094 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(dcl)) {
Nuno Lopes5773a1b2008-12-16 22:58:26 +00006095 // Okay: we can take the address of a function.
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006096 // As above.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006097 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier() &&
6098 MD->isInstance())
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006099 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6100 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6101 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Steve Narofff633d092007-04-25 19:01:39 +00006102 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006103 }
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006104
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006105 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6106 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6107 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6108 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6109 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6110 }
6111
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006112 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006113 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006114}
6115
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006116QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006117 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6118 return Context.DependentTy;
6119
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006120 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
6121 QualType Ty = Op->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006122
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006123 // Note that per both C89 and C99, this is always legal, even if ptype is an
6124 // incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about dereferencing
6125 // a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a warning is
6126 // unlikely to catch any mistakes.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006127 if (const PointerType *PT = Ty->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006128 return PT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006129
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006130 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
Fariborz Jahanianf15d4b62009-09-03 00:43:07 +00006131 return OPT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006132
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006133 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006134 << Ty << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006135 return QualType();
Steve Naroff1926c832007-04-24 00:23:05 +00006136}
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006137
6138static inline BinaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
6139 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6140 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6141 switch (Kind) {
6142 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006143 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemD; break;
6144 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemI; break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006145 case tok::star: Opc = BinaryOperator::Mul; break;
6146 case tok::slash: Opc = BinaryOperator::Div; break;
6147 case tok::percent: Opc = BinaryOperator::Rem; break;
6148 case tok::plus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Add; break;
6149 case tok::minus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Sub; break;
6150 case tok::lessless: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shl; break;
6151 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shr; break;
6152 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::LE; break;
6153 case tok::less: Opc = BinaryOperator::LT; break;
6154 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::GE; break;
6155 case tok::greater: Opc = BinaryOperator::GT; break;
6156 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::NE; break;
6157 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::EQ; break;
6158 case tok::amp: Opc = BinaryOperator::And; break;
6159 case tok::caret: Opc = BinaryOperator::Xor; break;
6160 case tok::pipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::Or; break;
6161 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BinaryOperator::LAnd; break;
6162 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::LOr; break;
6163 case tok::equal: Opc = BinaryOperator::Assign; break;
6164 case tok::starequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::MulAssign; break;
6165 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::DivAssign; break;
6166 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::RemAssign; break;
6167 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AddAssign; break;
6168 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::SubAssign; break;
6169 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShlAssign; break;
6170 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShrAssign; break;
6171 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AndAssign; break;
6172 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::XorAssign; break;
6173 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::OrAssign; break;
6174 case tok::comma: Opc = BinaryOperator::Comma; break;
6175 }
6176 return Opc;
6177}
6178
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006179static inline UnaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
6180 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6181 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6182 switch (Kind) {
6183 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
6184 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreInc; break;
6185 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreDec; break;
6186 case tok::amp: Opc = UnaryOperator::AddrOf; break;
6187 case tok::star: Opc = UnaryOperator::Deref; break;
6188 case tok::plus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Plus; break;
6189 case tok::minus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Minus; break;
6190 case tok::tilde: Opc = UnaryOperator::Not; break;
6191 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UnaryOperator::LNot; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006192 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UnaryOperator::Real; break;
6193 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UnaryOperator::Imag; break;
Chris Lattnerd0f76512007-06-08 22:16:53 +00006194 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UnaryOperator::Extension; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006195 }
6196 return Opc;
6197}
6198
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006199/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6200/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6201/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006202Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6203 unsigned Op,
6204 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006205 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006206 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)Op;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006207 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6208 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6209 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006210
6211 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006212 case BinaryOperator::Assign:
6213 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6214 break;
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006215 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemD:
6216 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemI:
6217 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
6218 Opc == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI);
6219 break;
6220 case BinaryOperator::Mul:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006221 case BinaryOperator::Div:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006222 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
6223 Opc == BinaryOperator::Div);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006224 break;
6225 case BinaryOperator::Rem:
6226 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6227 break;
6228 case BinaryOperator::Add:
6229 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6230 break;
6231 case BinaryOperator::Sub:
6232 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6233 break;
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006234 case BinaryOperator::Shl:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006235 case BinaryOperator::Shr:
6236 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6237 break;
6238 case BinaryOperator::LE:
6239 case BinaryOperator::LT:
6240 case BinaryOperator::GE:
6241 case BinaryOperator::GT:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006242 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006243 break;
6244 case BinaryOperator::EQ:
6245 case BinaryOperator::NE:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006246 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006247 break;
6248 case BinaryOperator::And:
6249 case BinaryOperator::Xor:
6250 case BinaryOperator::Or:
6251 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6252 break;
6253 case BinaryOperator::LAnd:
6254 case BinaryOperator::LOr:
6255 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6256 break;
6257 case BinaryOperator::MulAssign:
6258 case BinaryOperator::DivAssign:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006259 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
6260 Opc == BinaryOperator::DivAssign);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006261 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6262 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6263 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006264 break;
6265 case BinaryOperator::RemAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006266 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6267 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6268 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6269 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006270 break;
6271 case BinaryOperator::AddAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006272 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6273 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6274 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006275 break;
6276 case BinaryOperator::SubAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006277 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6278 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6279 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006280 break;
6281 case BinaryOperator::ShlAssign:
6282 case BinaryOperator::ShrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006283 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6284 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6285 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6286 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006287 break;
6288 case BinaryOperator::AndAssign:
6289 case BinaryOperator::XorAssign:
6290 case BinaryOperator::OrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006291 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6292 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6293 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6294 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006295 break;
6296 case BinaryOperator::Comma:
6297 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6298 break;
6299 }
6300 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006301 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006302 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006303 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6304 else
6305 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006306 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6307 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006308}
6309
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006310/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6311/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006312static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6313 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006314 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6315 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6316 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006317 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006318 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6319
6320 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6321 return;
6322
6323 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6324 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6325 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006326 return;
6327 }
6328
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006329 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6330 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006331 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006332
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006333 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006334 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006335
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006336 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6337 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6338 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6339 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006340 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006341 return;
6342 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006343
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006344 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006345 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6346 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006347}
6348
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006349/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6350/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6351/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6352/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006353static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6354 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006355 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6356 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6357 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6358 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006359 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006360 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006361 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6362
6363 // Subs are not binary operators.
6364 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6365 return;
6366
6367 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6368 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006369 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6370 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006371 return;
6372
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006373 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006374 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006375 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006376 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6377 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006378 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006379 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006380 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6381 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6382 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6383 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006384 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006385 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006386 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006387 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6388 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006389 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006390 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006391 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6392 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6393 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6394 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006395}
6396
6397/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6398/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6399/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
6400static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6401 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006402 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006403 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6404}
6405
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006406// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006407Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
6408 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6409 ExprArg LHS, ExprArg RHS) {
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006410 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00006411 Expr *lhs = LHS.takeAs<Expr>(), *rhs = RHS.takeAs<Expr>();
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006412
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006413 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6414 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006415
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006416 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6417 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6418
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006419 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6420}
6421
6422Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6423 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6424 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006425 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006426 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006427 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6428 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6429 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6430 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6431 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006432 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006433 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006434 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6435 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6436 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006437
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006438 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6439 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006440 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006441 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006442
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006443 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006444 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006445}
6446
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006447Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006448 unsigned OpcIn,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006449 ExprArg InputArg) {
6450 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006451
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006452 // FIXME: Input is modified below, but InputArg is not updated appropriately.
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006453 Expr *Input = (Expr *)InputArg.get();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006454 QualType resultType;
6455 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006456 case UnaryOperator::OffsetOf:
6457 assert(false && "Invalid unary operator");
6458 break;
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006459
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006460 case UnaryOperator::PreInc:
6461 case UnaryOperator::PreDec:
Eli Friedman6aea5752009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006462 case UnaryOperator::PostInc:
6463 case UnaryOperator::PostDec:
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006464 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
Eli Friedman6aea5752009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006465 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006466 Opc == UnaryOperator::PostInc,
6467 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
6468 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreDec);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006469 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006470 case UnaryOperator::AddrOf:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006471 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006472 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006473 case UnaryOperator::Deref:
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006474 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006475 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006476 break;
6477 case UnaryOperator::Plus:
6478 case UnaryOperator::Minus:
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006479 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6480 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006481 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6482 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006483 if (resultType->isArithmeticType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6484 break;
6485 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6486 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6487 break;
6488 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
6489 Opc == UnaryOperator::Plus &&
6490 resultType->isPointerType())
6491 break;
6492
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006493 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6494 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006495 case UnaryOperator::Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006496 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6497 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006498 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6499 break;
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006500 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6501 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6502 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006503 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006504 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006505 else if (!resultType->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006506 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6507 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006508 break;
6509 case UnaryOperator::LNot: // logical negation
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00006510 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006511 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006512 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006513 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6514 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006515 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006516 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6517 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattnerbe31ed82007-06-02 19:11:33 +00006518 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006519 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6520 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006521 break;
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006522 case UnaryOperator::Real:
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006523 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00006524 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UnaryOperator::Real);
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006525 break;
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006526 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006527 resultType = Input->getType();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00006528 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006529 }
6530 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006531 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006532
6533 InputArg.release();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006534 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006535}
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006536
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006537Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6538 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6539 ExprArg input) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006540 Expr *Input = (Expr*)input.get();
Anders Carlsson461a2c02009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006541 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
6542 Opc != UnaryOperator::Extension) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006543 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6544 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6545 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6546 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006547 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006548 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006549 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6550 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6551 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006552
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006553 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, move(input));
6554 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006555
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006556 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, move(input));
6557}
6558
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006559// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
6560Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6561 tok::TokenKind Op, ExprArg input) {
6562 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), move(input));
6563}
6564
Steve Naroff66356bd2007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006565/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006566Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6567 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6568 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006569 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
Chris Lattner3318e862009-04-18 20:01:55 +00006570 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getLabelMap()[LabelII];
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006571
Daniel Dunbar88402ce2008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006572 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6573 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroff846b1ec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006574 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006575 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006576
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006577 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006578 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6579 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006580}
6581
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006582Sema::OwningExprResult
6583Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, StmtArg substmt,
6584 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
6585 Stmt *SubStmt = static_cast<Stmt*>(substmt.get());
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006586 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6587 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6588
Douglas Gregor6cf3f3c2010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006589 bool isFileScope
6590 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattnera69b0762009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006591 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006592 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedman52cc0162009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006593
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006594 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6595 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6596 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006597
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006598 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6599 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6600 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006601
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006602 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6603 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6604 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6605 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6606 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006607
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006608 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006609 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006610 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006611
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006612 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6613 // expressions are not lvalues.
6614
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006615 substmt.release();
6616 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006617}
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006618
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006619Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6620 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006621 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6622 unsigned NumComponents,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006623 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6624 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006625 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006626 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange();
6627
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006628 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6629 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6630 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006631 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006632 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6633 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
6634
6635 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6636 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
6637 if (!Dependent
6638 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
6639 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
6640 << TypeRange))
6641 return ExprError();
6642
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006643 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6644 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006645 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6646 // a system header!
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006647 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006648 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6649 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006650
6651 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
6652 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
6653 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
6654 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
6655 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
6656 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6657 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6658 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6659 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6660 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6661 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
6662 if(!AT)
6663 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
6664 << CurrentType);
6665 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
6666 } else
6667 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6668
6669 // The expression must be an integral expression.
6670 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
6671 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
6672 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
6673 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
6674 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
6675 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
6676 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6677
6678 // Record this array index.
6679 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
6680 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
6681 continue;
6682 }
6683
6684 // Offset of a field.
6685 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6686 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
6687 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
6688 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
6689 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6690 continue;
6691 }
6692
6693 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
6694 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
6695 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6696 return ExprError();
6697
6698 // Look for the designated field.
6699 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
6700 if (!RC)
6701 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6702 << CurrentType);
6703 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
6704
6705 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
6706 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
6707 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
6708 // (clause 9).
6709 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
6710 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6711 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6712 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
6713 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6714 << CurrentType))
6715 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
6716 }
6717
6718 // Look for the field.
6719 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6720 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
6721 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
6722 if (!MemberDecl)
6723 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
6724 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
6725 OC.LocEnd));
6726
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006727 // C99 7.17p3:
6728 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6729 //
6730 // We diagnose this as an error.
6731 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6732 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6733 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6734 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
6735 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6736 return ExprError();
6737 }
6738
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006739 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006740 isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006741 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
6742 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
6743 unsigned n = Path.size();
6744 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
6745 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
6746 } else {
6747 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
6748 }
6749 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
6750 }
6751
6752 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
6753 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
6754 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
6755}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006756
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006757Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
6758 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6759 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
6760 TypeTy *argty,
6761 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6762 unsigned NumComponents,
6763 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6764
6765 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
6766 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
6767 if (ArgTy.isNull())
6768 return ExprError();
6769
6770 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6771 if (!ArgTInfo)
6772 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
6773
6774 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
6775 RPLoc);
6776 }
6777
6778 // FIXME: The code below is marked for death, once we have proper CodeGen
6779 // support for non-constant OffsetOf expressions.
6780
6781 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
6782
6783 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6784 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6785 // a struct/union/class.
6786 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
6787 return ExprError(Diag(TypeLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type) << ArgTy);
6788
6789 // FIXME: Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6790 // with an incomplete type would be illegal.
6791
6792 // Otherwise, create a null pointer as the base, and iteratively process
6793 // the offsetof designators.
6794 QualType ArgTyPtr = Context.getPointerType(ArgTy);
6795 Expr* Res = new (Context) ImplicitValueInitExpr(ArgTyPtr);
6796 Res = new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::Deref,
6797 ArgTy, SourceLocation());
6798
6799 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6800 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
6801 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6802 // a system header!
6803 if (NumComponents != 1)
6804 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6805 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
6806
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006807 if (!Dependent) {
Eli Friedman8469bc72009-05-03 21:22:18 +00006808 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006809
John McCall9eff4e62009-11-04 03:03:43 +00006810 if (RequireCompleteType(TypeLoc, Res->getType(),
6811 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6812 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006813
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006814 // FIXME: Dependent case loses a lot of information here. And probably
6815 // leaks like a sieve.
6816 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6817 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6818 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6819 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6820 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(Res->getType());
6821 if (!AT) {
6822 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006823 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006824 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006825 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006826
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006827 // FIXME: C++: Verify that operator[] isn't overloaded.
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006828
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006829 // Promote the array so it looks more like a normal array subscript
6830 // expression.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006831 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Res);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006832
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006833 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
6834 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006835 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006836 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006837 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00006838 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006839 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6840
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006841 Res = new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(Res, Idx, AT->getElementType(),
6842 OC.LocEnd);
6843 continue;
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006844 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006845
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006846 const RecordType *RC = Res->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006847 if (!RC) {
6848 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006849 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006850 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006851 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006852
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006853 // Get the decl corresponding to this.
6854 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
Anders Carlsson2bbb86b2009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006855 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00006856 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6857 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6858 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006859 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6860 << Res->getType()))
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00006861 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
Anders Carlsson2bbb86b2009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006862 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006863
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00006864 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6865 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006866
John McCall67c00872009-12-02 08:25:40 +00006867 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006868 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006869 if (!MemberDecl)
Douglas Gregore40876a2009-10-13 21:16:44 +00006870 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006871 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart, OC.LocEnd));
6872
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006873 // C99 7.17p3:
6874 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6875 //
6876 // We diagnose this as an error.
6877 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6878 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6879 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6880 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
6881 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6882 return ExprError();
6883 }
6884
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006885 // FIXME: C++: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a static field.
6886 // FIXME: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a bitfield.
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006887 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Anders Carlsson3cbc8592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00006888 Res = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006889 OC.LocEnd, MemberDecl, Res, OC.LocEnd).takeAs<Expr>();
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006890 } else {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006891 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Res, /*Qualifier=*/0,
6892 *R.begin(), MemberDecl);
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006893 // MemberDecl->getType() doesn't get the right qualifiers, but it
6894 // doesn't matter here.
6895 Res = new (Context) MemberExpr(Res, false, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006896 MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType());
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006897 }
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006898 }
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006899 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006900
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006901 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::OffsetOf,
6902 Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc));
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006903}
6904
6905
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006906Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6907 TypeTy *arg1,TypeTy *arg2,
6908 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc7148c92009-08-19 01:28:28 +00006909 // FIXME: Preserve type source info.
6910 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1);
6911 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006912
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006913 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006914
Douglas Gregorf907cbf2009-05-19 22:28:02 +00006915 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6916 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
6917 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
6918 return ExprError();
6919 }
6920
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006921 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
6922 argT1, argT2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006923}
6924
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006925Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6926 ExprArg cond,
6927 ExprArg expr1, ExprArg expr2,
6928 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6929 Expr *CondExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(cond.get());
6930 Expr *LHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr1.get());
6931 Expr *RHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr2.get());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006932
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006933 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
6934
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006935 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006936 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregor0df91122009-05-19 22:43:30 +00006937 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006938 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006939 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006940 } else {
6941 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
6942 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
6943 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
6944 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006945 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
6946 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
6947 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006948
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006949 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
6950 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006951 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
6952 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006953 }
6954
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006955 cond.release(); expr1.release(); expr2.release();
6956 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006957 resType, RPLoc,
6958 resType->isDependentType(),
6959 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006960}
6961
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006962//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6963// Clang Extensions.
6964//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6965
6966/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006967void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00006968 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
6969 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
6970 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
6971 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006972}
6973
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006974void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00006975 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00006976 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006977
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006978 if (ParamInfo.getNumTypeObjects() == 0
6979 || ParamInfo.getTypeObject(0).Kind != DeclaratorChunk::Function) {
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00006980 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006981 QualType T = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
6982
Mike Stumpd456c482009-04-28 01:10:27 +00006983 if (T->isArrayType()) {
6984 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
6985 diag::err_block_returns_array);
6986 return;
6987 }
6988
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006989 // The parameter list is optional, if there was none, assume ().
6990 if (!T->isFunctionType())
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00006991 T = Context.getFunctionType(T, 0, 0, false, 0, false, false, 0, 0,
6992 FunctionType::ExtInfo());
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006993
6994 CurBlock->hasPrototype = true;
6995 CurBlock->isVariadic = false;
Fariborz Jahanian6607b212009-05-14 20:53:39 +00006996 // Check for a valid sentinel attribute on this block.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00006997 if (CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006998 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
Fariborz Jahanian6802ed92009-05-15 21:18:04 +00006999 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
Fariborz Jahanian6607b212009-05-14 20:53:39 +00007000 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7001 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007002 QualType RetTy = T.getTypePtr()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getResultType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007003
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007004 // Do not allow returning a objc interface by-value.
7005 if (RetTy->isObjCInterfaceType()) {
7006 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7007 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7008 return;
7009 }
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007010
7011 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007012 return;
7013 }
7014
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007015 // Analyze arguments to block.
7016 assert(ParamInfo.getTypeObject(0).Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Function &&
7017 "Not a function declarator!");
7018 DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = ParamInfo.getTypeObject(0).Fun;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007019
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007020 CurBlock->hasPrototype = FTI.hasPrototype;
7021 CurBlock->isVariadic = true;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007022
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007023 // Check for C99 6.7.5.3p10 - foo(void) is a non-varargs function that takes
7024 // no arguments, not a function that takes a single void argument.
7025 if (FTI.hasPrototype &&
7026 FTI.NumArgs == 1 && !FTI.isVariadic && FTI.ArgInfo[0].Ident == 0 &&
Chris Lattner83f095c2009-03-28 19:18:32 +00007027 (!FTI.ArgInfo[0].Param.getAs<ParmVarDecl>()->getType().getCVRQualifiers()&&
7028 FTI.ArgInfo[0].Param.getAs<ParmVarDecl>()->getType()->isVoidType())) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007029 // empty arg list, don't push any params.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007030 CurBlock->isVariadic = false;
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007031 } else if (FTI.hasPrototype) {
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007032 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FTI.NumArgs; i != e; ++i) {
7033 ParmVarDecl *Param = FTI.ArgInfo[i].Param.getAs<ParmVarDecl>();
7034 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7035 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7036 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7037 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7038 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
7039 CurBlock->Params.push_back(Param);
7040 }
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007041 CurBlock->isVariadic = FTI.isVariadic;
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007042 }
Douglas Gregord5058122010-02-11 01:19:42 +00007043 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(CurBlock->Params.data(),
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007044 CurBlock->Params.size());
Fariborz Jahanian960910a2009-05-19 17:08:59 +00007045 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(CurBlock->isVariadic);
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007046 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007047
7048 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7049 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7050
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007051 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007052 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7053 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7054
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007055 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007056 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7057 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7058 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7059
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007060 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007061 }
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007062 }
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007063
Fariborz Jahanian6607b212009-05-14 20:53:39 +00007064 // Check for a valid sentinel attribute on this block.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007065 if (!CurBlock->isVariadic &&
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00007066 CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007067 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
Fariborz Jahanian6802ed92009-05-15 21:18:04 +00007068 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
Fariborz Jahanian6607b212009-05-14 20:53:39 +00007069 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7070 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007071
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007072 // Analyze the return type.
7073 QualType T = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007074 QualType RetTy = T->getAs<FunctionType>()->getResultType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007075
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007076 // Do not allow returning a objc interface by-value.
7077 if (RetTy->isObjCInterfaceType()) {
7078 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7079 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7080 } else if (!RetTy->isDependentType())
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007081 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007082}
7083
7084/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7085/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7086void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007087 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner41b86942009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007088 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007089 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007090 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007091}
7092
7093/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7094/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007095Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
7096 StmtArg body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9eac9312009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007097 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7098 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7099 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007100
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007101 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007102
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007103 PopDeclContext();
7104
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007105 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007106 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7107 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007108
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007109 llvm::SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
7110 for (unsigned i = 0, e = BSI->Params.size(); i != e; ++i)
7111 ArgTypes.push_back(BSI->Params[i]->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007112
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007113 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007114 QualType BlockTy;
7115 if (!BSI->hasPrototype)
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007116 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0, false, false, 0, 0,
Rafael Espindola49b85ab2010-03-30 22:15:11 +00007117 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007118 else
Jay Foad7d0479f2009-05-21 09:52:38 +00007119 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, ArgTypes.data(), ArgTypes.size(),
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007120 BSI->isVariadic, 0, false, false, 0, 0,
Rafael Espindola49b85ab2010-03-30 22:15:11 +00007121 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007122
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007123 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007124 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->Params.begin(), BSI->Params.end());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007125 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007126
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007127 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007128 if (FunctionNeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007129 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(static_cast<CompoundStmt*>(body.get()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007130
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00007131 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(body.takeAs<CompoundStmt>());
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007132
7133 bool Good = true;
7134 // Check goto/label use.
7135 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7136 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7137 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7138
7139 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7140 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
7141 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0)
7142 continue;
7143
7144 // Emit error.
7145 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7146 Good = false;
7147 }
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007148 if (!Good) {
7149 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007150 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007151 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007152
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007153 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenek0b405322010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007154 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7155 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
7156 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy);
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007157
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007158 Expr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7159 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007160 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007161 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007162}
7163
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007164Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7165 ExprArg expr, TypeTy *type,
7166 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc7148c92009-08-19 01:28:28 +00007167 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type);
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007168 Expr *E = static_cast<Expr*>(expr.get());
7169 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007170
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007171 InitBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007172
7173 // Get the va_list type
7174 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007175 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7176 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7177 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7178 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007179 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007180 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7181 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7182 } else {
7183 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7184 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007185 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007186 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007187 return ExprError();
7188 }
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007189
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007190 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7191 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007192 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7193 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007194 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner3f5cd772009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007195 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007196
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007197 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007198 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007199
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007200 expr.release();
7201 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, T.getNonReferenceType(),
7202 RPLoc));
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007203}
7204
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007205Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007206 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7207 // pointers on the target.
7208 QualType Ty;
7209 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7210 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7211 else
7212 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7213
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007214 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007215}
7216
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007217static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007218 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007219 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7220 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007221
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007222 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7223 if (!PT)
7224 return;
7225
7226 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7227 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7228 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7229 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7230 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7231 return;
7232 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007233
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007234 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7235 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7236 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7237 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007238
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007239 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007240}
7241
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007242bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7243 SourceLocation Loc,
7244 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007245 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7246 bool *Complained) {
7247 if (Complained)
7248 *Complained = false;
7249
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007250 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7251 bool isInvalid = false;
7252 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007253 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007254
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007255 switch (ConvTy) {
7256 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7257 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007258 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007259 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7260 break;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007261 case IntToPointer:
7262 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7263 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007264 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007265 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007266 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7267 break;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007268 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7269 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7270 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007271 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7272 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7273 break;
7274 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007275 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7276 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7277 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7278 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7279 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7280 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7281 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7282 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7283 // C++ semantics.
7284 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7285 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7286 return false;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007287 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7288 break;
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007289 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanianb98dade2009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007290 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007291 break;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007292 case IntToBlockPointer:
7293 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7294 break;
7295 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stumpd79b5a82009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007296 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007297 break;
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007298 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007299 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007300 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7301 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7302 break;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007303 case IncompatibleVectors:
7304 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7305 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007306 case Incompatible:
7307 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7308 isInvalid = true;
7309 break;
7310 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007311
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007312 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7313 switch (Action) {
7314 case AA_Assigning:
7315 case AA_Initializing:
7316 // The destination type comes first.
7317 FirstType = DstType;
7318 SecondType = SrcType;
7319 break;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007320
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007321 case AA_Returning:
7322 case AA_Passing:
7323 case AA_Converting:
7324 case AA_Sending:
7325 case AA_Casting:
7326 // The source type comes first.
7327 FirstType = SrcType;
7328 SecondType = DstType;
7329 break;
7330 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007331
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007332 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007333 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007334 if (Complained)
7335 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007336 return isInvalid;
7337}
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007338
Chris Lattnerc71d08b2009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007339bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007340 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7341 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7342 if (Result)
7343 *Result = ICEResult;
7344 return false;
7345 }
7346
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007347 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7348
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007349 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007350 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7351 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7352
7353 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7354 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7355 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7356 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7357 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7358 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7359 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007360
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007361 return true;
7362 }
7363
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007364 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7365 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007366
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007367 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7368 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7369 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007370
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007371 if (Result)
7372 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7373 return false;
7374}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007375
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007376void
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007377Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007378 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7379 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007380}
7381
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007382void
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007383Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7384 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7385 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7386 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007387
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007388 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7389 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7390 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7391 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7392 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007393 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007394 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7395 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7396 I != IEnd; ++I)
7397 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7398 }
7399
7400 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7401 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7402 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7403 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7404 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7405 I != IEnd; ++I)
7406 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7407 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007408 }
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007409
7410 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7411 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7412 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7413 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007414 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007415 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7416 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7417 ExprTemporaries.end());
7418
7419 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7420 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007421}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007422
7423/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7424///
7425/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7426/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7427/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7428/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7429///
7430/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7431///
7432/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7433void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7434 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007435
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007436 if (D->isUsed())
7437 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007438
Douglas Gregor3beaf9b2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007439 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7440 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7441 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7442 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007443 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007444 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007445 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007446 return;
7447 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007448
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007449 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7450 return;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007451
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007452 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7453 // an instantiation.
7454 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7455 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007456
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007457 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007458 case Unevaluated:
7459 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7460 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007461
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007462 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7463 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7464 // "used"; handle this below.
7465 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007466
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007467 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7468 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7469 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7470 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007471 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007472 return;
7473 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007474
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007475 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanian3a363432009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007476 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007477 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007478 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
7479 if (!Constructor->isUsed())
7480 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007481 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007482 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007483 if (!Constructor->isUsed())
7484 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7485 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007486
Anders Carlsson82fccd02009-12-07 08:24:59 +00007487 MaybeMarkVirtualMembersReferenced(Loc, Constructor);
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007488 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
7489 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed())
7490 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007491
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007492 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7493 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7494 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
7495 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed())
7496 DefineImplicitOverloadedAssign(Loc, MethodDecl);
7497 }
7498 }
Fariborz Jahanian49796cc72009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007499 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007500 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor4adbc6d2009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007501 // class templates.
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007502 if (!Function->getBody() && Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007503 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7504 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7505 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7506 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7507 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007508 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007509 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007510 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007511 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007512 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7513 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7514 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007515 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007516 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007517 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7518 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007519
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007520 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7521 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7522 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7523 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7524 Loc));
7525 else
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007526 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007527 Loc));
7528 }
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007529 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007530
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007531 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007532 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007533
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007534 return;
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007535 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007536
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007537 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007538 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007539 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007540 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7541 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7542 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7543 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7544 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7545 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
7546 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
7547 }
7548 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007549
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007550 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007551
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007552 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007553 return;
Sam Weinigbae69142009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007554 }
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007555}
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007556
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007557/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7558/// of the program being compiled.
7559///
7560/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007561/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007562/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7563/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7564/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7565/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007566/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007567/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007568///
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007569/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7570/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7571/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7572/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007573bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007574 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7575 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7576 case Unevaluated:
7577 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7578 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007579
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007580 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7581 Diag(Loc, PD);
7582 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007583
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007584 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7585 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7586 break;
7587 }
7588
7589 return false;
7590}
7591
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007592bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7593 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7594 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7595 return false;
7596
7597 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7598 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7599 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7600 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007601
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007602 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007603 FD ?
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007604 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
7605 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007606 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007607 << CE->getSourceRange(),
7608 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
7609 return true;
7610
7611 return false;
7612}
7613
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007614// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
7615// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
7616void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
7617 SourceLocation Loc;
7618
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007619 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
7620
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007621 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
7622 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
7623 if (Op->getOpcode() != BinaryOperator::Assign)
7624 return;
7625
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007626 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
7627 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
7628 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
7629 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
7630
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007631 // self = [<foo> init...]
7632 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
7633 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
7634 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7635
7636 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
7637 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
7638 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
7639 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7640 }
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007641
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007642 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7643 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
7644 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
7645 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
7646 return;
7647
7648 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7649 } else {
7650 // Not an assignment.
7651 return;
7652 }
7653
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007654 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCalle724ae92009-10-12 22:25:59 +00007655 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007656
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007657 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007658 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007659 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007660 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
7661 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
7662 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007663}
7664
7665bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
7666 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
7667
7668 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007669 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007670
7671 QualType T = E->getType();
7672
7673 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7674 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
7675 return true;
7676 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
7677 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
7678 << T << E->getSourceRange();
7679 return true;
7680 }
7681 }
7682
7683 return false;
7684}